blob: ac9dec4e6c92a89bc17d9b7b78af69c243834e4d [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000024#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
25#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034#include <algorithm>
35
36namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000037using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000038
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000039/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
42 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000043 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
44 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000045 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000046 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
47 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
48 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000049
50 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
51 S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc);
52
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000053 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000054 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
55 if (E.isInvalid())
56 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000057 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000058}
59
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000060static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
61 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000062 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000063 bool CStyle,
64 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000065
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000066static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
67 QualType &ToType,
68 bool InOverloadResolution,
69 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
70 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000071static OverloadingResult
72IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
73 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
74 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
75 bool AllowExplicit);
76
77
78static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
79CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
82
83static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
84CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
86 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
87
88static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
89CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
90 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
91 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
92
93
94
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000095/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
96/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000097ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000098GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
99 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
100 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
101 ICC_Identity,
102 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
103 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
104 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000105 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
107 ICC_Promotion,
108 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000109 ICC_Promotion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
115 ICC_Conversion,
116 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000117 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000118 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000119 ICC_Conversion,
120 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000121 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000122 ICC_Conversion
123 };
124 return Category[(int)Kind];
125}
126
127/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
128/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
129ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
130 static const ImplicitConversionRank
131 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
132 ICR_Exact_Match,
133 ICR_Exact_Match,
134 ICR_Exact_Match,
135 ICR_Exact_Match,
136 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000137 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000138 ICR_Promotion,
139 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000140 ICR_Promotion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000149 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000150 ICR_Conversion,
151 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000152 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000154 ICR_Conversion,
155 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000156 };
157 return Rank[(int)Kind];
158}
159
160/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
161/// implicit conversion.
162const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000163 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "No conversion",
165 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
166 "Array-to-pointer",
167 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000168 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000169 "Qualification",
170 "Integral promotion",
171 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000172 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 "Integral conversion",
174 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000175 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000176 "Floating-integral conversion",
177 "Pointer conversion",
178 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000179 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000180 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000181 "Derived-to-base conversion",
182 "Vector conversion",
183 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000184 "Complex-real conversion",
185 "Block Pointer conversion",
186 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000187 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000188 };
189 return Name[Kind];
190}
191
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000192/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
193/// sequence to the identity conversion.
194void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
195 First = ICK_Identity;
196 Second = ICK_Identity;
197 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000198 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000199 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000200 ReferenceBinding = false;
201 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000202 IsLvalueReference = true;
203 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
204 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000205 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000206 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000207 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000208}
209
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
211/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
212/// implicit conversions.
213ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
214 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
215 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
216 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
217 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
218 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
219 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
220 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
221 return Rank;
222}
223
224/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
225/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000226/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000227/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000228bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
230 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
231 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
232 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000233 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000234 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000237 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
239 return true;
240
241 return false;
242}
243
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
245/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
246/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
247/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000249StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000250isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000251 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000252 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253
254 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
255 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
256 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
257 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
258 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
259
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000260 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000261 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000262 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
263
264 return false;
265}
266
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000267/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
268/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
269static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
270 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
271 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
272 case CK_NoOp:
273 case CK_IntegralCast:
274 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
275 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
276 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
277 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
278 case CK_FloatingCast:
279 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
280 continue;
281
282 default:
283 return Converted;
284 }
285 }
286
287 return Converted;
288}
289
290/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
291/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
292///
293/// \param Ctx The AST context.
294/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
295/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
296/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000297/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
298/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000299NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000300StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
301 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000302 APValue &ConstantValue,
303 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000304 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000305
306 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
307 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
308 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
309 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
310 switch (Second) {
311 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
312 //
313 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
314 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
315 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
316 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
317 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
318 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
319 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
320 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
321 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
322 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
323 if (Initializer &&
324 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
325 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
326 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
327 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
328 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
329 // And back.
330 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
331 bool ignored;
332 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
333 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
334 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
335 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
336 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000337 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000338 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
339 }
340 } else {
341 // Variables are always narrowings.
342 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
343 }
344 }
345 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
346
347 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
348 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
349 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
350 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
351 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
352 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
353 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
354 // FromType is larger than ToType.
355 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
356 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
357 // Constant!
358 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
359 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
360 // Convert the source value into the target type.
361 bool ignored;
362 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
363 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
364 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
365 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
366 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000367 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
368 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000369 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000370 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000371 } else {
372 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
373 }
374 }
375 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
376
377 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
378 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
379 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
380 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
381 // value when converted back to the original type.
382 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
383 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
384 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
385 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
386 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
387 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
388 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
389 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
390 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
391 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
392 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
393 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
394 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
395
396 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000397 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
398 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000399 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
400 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
401 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000402 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
403 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
404 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000405 }
406 bool Narrowing = false;
407 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000408 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
409 // narrowing.
410 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000411 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000412 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000413 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
414 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
415 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
416 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
417 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
418 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
419 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
420 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
421 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
422 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
423 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000424 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
425 Narrowing = true;
426 }
427 if (Narrowing) {
428 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
429 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
430 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000431 }
432 }
433 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
434 }
435
436 default:
437 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
438 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
439 }
440}
441
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
443/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
444void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000445 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000446 bool PrintedSomething = false;
447 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000448 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000449 PrintedSomething = true;
450 }
451
452 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
453 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000456 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000457
458 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000459 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000460 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000461 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000462 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000463 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000464 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 PrintedSomething = true;
466 }
467
468 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
469 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000470 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000471 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000473 PrintedSomething = true;
474 }
475
476 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000477 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000478 }
479}
480
481/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
482/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
483void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000484 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000485 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
486 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000487 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000488 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000489 if (ConversionFunction)
490 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
491 else
492 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000493 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000494 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 After.DebugPrint();
496 }
497}
498
499/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
500/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
501void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000502 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000503 switch (ConversionKind) {
504 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000505 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000506 Standard.DebugPrint();
507 break;
508 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000509 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000510 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
511 break;
512 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000513 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000514 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000515 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000516 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000517 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000518 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000519 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000520 break;
521 }
522
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000523 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000524}
525
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000526void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
527 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
528}
529
530void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
531 conversions().~ConversionSet();
532}
533
534void
535AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
536 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
537 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
538 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
539}
540
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000541namespace {
542 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000543 // template argument information.
544 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000545 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
546 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
547 };
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000548 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
549 // template parameter and template argument information.
550 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
551 TemplateParameter Param;
552 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000554
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
556/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
557OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000558static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
559 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000560 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000561 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
562 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000563 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 Result.Data = 0;
565 switch (TDK) {
566 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000567 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000568 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000569 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
570 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000571 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000572
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000574 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
576 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000577
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000578 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
579 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
580 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
581 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
582 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
583 Result.Data = Saved;
584 break;
585 }
586
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000588 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000589 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
590 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000591 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
592 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
593 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
594 Result.Data = Saved;
595 break;
596 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000597
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000598 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000599 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000600 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
601 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
602 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
603 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
604 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
605 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000606 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000607
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000609 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
610 break;
611
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000612 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000613 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000614 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000615
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return Result;
617}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000618
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
620 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
621 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000622 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000623 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
624 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
626 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000627 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000628 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000629 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000630
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000631 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000632 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000633 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000634 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000635 Data = 0;
636 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000637
638 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000639 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000640 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000641 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
642 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
643 HasDiagnostic = false;
644 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000645 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000646
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000647 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000648 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 break;
650 }
651}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000652
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000653PartialDiagnosticAt *
654OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
655 if (HasDiagnostic)
656 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
657 return 0;
658}
659
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000660TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
662 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
663 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000665 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000666 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
667 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
670 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000671 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000674 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000675 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000676
677 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000678 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000679 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000680
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000681 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000683 break;
684 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000685
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return TemplateParameter();
687}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000688
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000689TemplateArgumentList *
690OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
691 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000692 case Sema::TDK_Success:
693 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
694 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
695 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
696 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
697 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
698 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
699 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
700 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
701 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
702 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
703 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000704
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000705 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
706 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000707
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000708 // Unhandled
709 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
710 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000711 }
712
713 return 0;
714}
715
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000716const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
717 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
718 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000719 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000720 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
721 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000722 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
723 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000724 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000725 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000726 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000727 return 0;
728
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
732 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000733
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000734 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 break;
737 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000738
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000739 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000740}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000741
742const TemplateArgument *
743OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
744 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
745 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000746 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000747 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
748 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000749 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
750 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000751 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000752 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000753 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000754 return 0;
755
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000757 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
759 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000760
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000761 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000763 break;
764 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000765
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000766 return 0;
767}
768
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000769Expr *
770OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
771 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
772 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
773 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
774
775 return 0;
776}
777
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000778void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000779 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000780 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
781 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000782 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
783 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
784 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000785}
786
787void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
788 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000789 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000790 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000791 Functions.clear();
792}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000793
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000794namespace {
795 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
796 struct Entry {
797 Expr **Addr;
798 Expr *Saved;
799 };
800 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
801
802 public:
803 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
804 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
805 Entry entry = { &E, E };
806 Entries.push_back(entry);
807 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
808 }
809
810 void restore() {
811 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
812 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
813 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
814 }
815 };
816}
817
818/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
819/// preprocessing on the given expression.
820///
821/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
822/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
823///
824/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
825static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
826 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000827 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
828 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
829 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
830 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
831
832 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
833 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
834 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
835 unbridgedCasts) {
836 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
837 return false;
838 }
839
840 // Go ahead and check everything else.
841 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
842 if (result.isInvalid())
843 return true;
844
845 E = result.take();
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Nothing to do.
850 return false;
851}
852
853/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
854/// placeholders.
855static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
856 unsigned numArgs,
857 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
858 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
859 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
860 return true;
861
862 return false;
863}
864
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000865// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000866// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
867// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
868// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
869// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000870// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
871// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
872// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000873//
874// Example: Given the following input:
875//
876// void f(int, float); // #1
877// void f(int, int); // #2
878// int f(int, int); // #3
879//
880// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000881// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000883// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
884// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
885// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
886// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000887//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000888// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
889// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
890// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
891// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000892// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
893// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000894//
895// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
896// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
897// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
898// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000899Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000900Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
901 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000902 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000903 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000904 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
905
906 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
907 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
908 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
909
910 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
911 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
912 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
913
914 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
915 }
916
917 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
918 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
919 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
920 // function templates hide function templates with different
921 // return types or template parameter lists.
922 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
923 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
924
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000925 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000926 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
927 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
928 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
929 continue;
930 }
931
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000932 Match = *I;
933 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000934 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000935 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000942 Match = *I;
943 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000944 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000945 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000946 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
947 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
948 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000949 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
950 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000951 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
952 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
953 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
954 // template instantiation.
955 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000956 // (C++ 13p1):
957 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
958 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000959 Match = *I;
960 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000961 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000962 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000963
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000964 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000965}
966
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000967static bool canBeOverloaded(const FunctionDecl &D) {
968 if (D.getAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
969 return true;
970 if (D.hasCLanguageLinkage())
971 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000972
973 // Main cannot be overloaded (basic.start.main).
974 if (D.isMain())
975 return false;
976
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000977 return true;
978}
979
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000980bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
981 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000982 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
983 // overloads.
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000984 if (!canBeOverloaded(*Old) && !canBeOverloaded(*New))
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000985 return false;
986
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000987 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
988 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
989
990 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
991 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
992 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
993 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
994 return true;
995
996 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
997 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
998 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
999
1000 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1001 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1002 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1003
1004 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1005 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1006 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1007 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1008 return false;
1009
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001010 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1011 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001012
1013 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1014 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1015 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1016 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1017 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1018 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001019 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001020 return true;
1021
1022 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1023 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1024 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1025 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1026 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1027 // signature.
1028 //
1029 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1030 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001031 //
1032 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1033 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1034 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001035 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1036 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1037 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1038 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1039 return true;
1040
1041 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001042 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001043 //
1044 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1045 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1046 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1047 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1048 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001049 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1050 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001051 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001052 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1053 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1054 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1055 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1056 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1057 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1058 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1059 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1060 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1061 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1062 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1063 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1064 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1065 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1066 }
1067 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001068 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001069
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001070 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1071 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1072 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1073 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1074 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith714fcc12013-01-14 08:00:39 +00001075 if (NewMethod->isConstexpr() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001076 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1077 if (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewQuals)
1078 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001079 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001080
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001081 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1082 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001083}
1084
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001085/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1086/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1087///
1088/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1089/// an available function, false otherwise.
1090bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1091 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1092}
1093
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001094/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1095///
1096/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1097/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1098static ImplicitConversionSequence
1099TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1100 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1101 bool AllowExplicit,
1102 bool InOverloadResolution,
1103 bool CStyle,
1104 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1105 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1106
1107 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1108 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1109 // we can perform.
1110 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1111 return ICS;
1112 }
1113
1114 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1115 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1116 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1117 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1118 AllowExplicit);
1119
1120 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1121 ICS.setUserDefined();
1122 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1123 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1124 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1125 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1126 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1127 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1128 // called for those cases.
1129 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1130 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1131 QualType FromCanon
1132 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1133 QualType ToCanon
1134 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1135 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1136 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1137 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1138 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1139 ICS.setStandard();
1140 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1141 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1142 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1143 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1144 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1145 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1146 }
1147 }
1148
1149 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1150 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1151 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1152 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1153 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1154 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1155 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1156 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1157 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1158 }
1159 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1160 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1161 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1162 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1163 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1164 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1165 if (Cand->Viable)
1166 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1167 } else {
1168 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1169 }
1170
1171 return ICS;
1172}
1173
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001174/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1175/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1176/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1177/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001178///
1179/// void f(float f);
1180/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1181///
1182/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1183/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1184/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1185/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1186//
1187/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1188/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1189/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1190/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1191/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001192///
1193/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1194/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001195/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1196/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001197///
1198/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1199/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1200/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001201static ImplicitConversionSequence
1202TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1203 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001204 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001205 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001206 bool CStyle,
1207 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001208 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001210 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001211 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001212 return ICS;
1213 }
1214
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001215 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001216 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001217 return ICS;
1218 }
1219
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001220 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1221 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1222 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1223 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1224 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1225 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1226 // called for those cases.
1227 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1228 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001229 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1230 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001231 ICS.setStandard();
1232 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1233 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1234 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001235
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001236 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1237 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1238 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1239 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1240 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001241
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001242 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001244 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001245
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001246 return ICS;
1247 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001249 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1250 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1251 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001252}
1253
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001254ImplicitConversionSequence
1255Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1256 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1257 bool AllowExplicit,
1258 bool InOverloadResolution,
1259 bool CStyle,
1260 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1261 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1262 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1263 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1264 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001265}
1266
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001267/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001268/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001269/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1270/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1271/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001272ExprResult
1273Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001274 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001275 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001276 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001277}
1278
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279ExprResult
1280Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001281 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001282 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001283 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1284 return ExprError();
1285
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001286 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1287 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001288 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001289 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001290
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001291 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1292 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1293 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001294 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001295 /*CStyle=*/false,
1296 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001297 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1298}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001299
1300/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001301/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001302bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1303 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001304 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1305 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001306
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001307 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1308 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1309 // - a pointer
1310 // - a member pointer
1311 // - a block pointer
1312 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1313 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1314 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1315 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1316 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1317 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1318 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1319 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1320 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1321 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1322 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1323 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1324 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1325 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1326 } else {
1327 return false;
1328 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001329
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001330 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1331 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1332 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1333 return false;
1334 }
1335
1336 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1337 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1338 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1339
1340 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1341 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1342 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1343
1344 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001345 return true;
1346}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001347
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001348/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1349/// vector conversion.
1350///
1351/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1352/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001353static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1354 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001355 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1356 // conversion.
1357 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1358 return false;
1359
1360 // Identical types require no conversions.
1361 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1362 return false;
1363
1364 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1365 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1366 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1367 // identity conversion.
1368 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1369 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001370
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001371 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001372 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001373 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1374 return true;
1375 }
1376 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001377
1378 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1379 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1380 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1381 // same size
1382 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1383 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001384 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001385 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001386 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1387 return true;
1388 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001389 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001390
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001391 return false;
1392}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001393
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001394static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1395 bool InOverloadResolution,
1396 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1397 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001398
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001399/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1400/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1401/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1402/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1403/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1404/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1405/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1406/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001407static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1408 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001409 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001410 bool CStyle,
1411 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001412 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001413
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001415 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001416 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001417 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001418 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001419 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001420
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001421 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001422 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001423 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001424 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001425 return false;
1426
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001427 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001428 }
1429
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001430 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1431 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1432 // (C++ 4p1).
1433
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001435 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1436 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001437 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001439 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1440 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1441 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001442
1443 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1444 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1445 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1446 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1447 QualType resultTy;
1448 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001449 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001450 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1451 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1452 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1453 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001454 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001455
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001456 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1457 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1458 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1459 // expression.
1460 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1461 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1462 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1463 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1464 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1465 == UO_AddrOf &&
1466 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1467 const Type *ClassType
1468 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1469 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001470 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1471 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1472 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001473 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1474 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1475 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001476
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001477 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001478 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1479 FromType,
1480 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001481 } else {
1482 return false;
1483 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001484 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001485 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1486 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1487 // be converted to a prvalue.
1488 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001489 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001490 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001491 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001493
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001494 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1495 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1496 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1497 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1498 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1499
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001500 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1501 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001502 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1503 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001504 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001505 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1506 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001507 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001508
1509 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1510 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1511 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001512 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001513
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001514 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001516 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001517
1518 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1519 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1520 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1521 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001522 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1523 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001525 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001526 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001527 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001528 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001529 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001530 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001531
1532 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1533 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1534 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001535 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001536 } else {
1537 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001538 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001539 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001540 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001541
1542 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1543 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1544 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1545 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001546 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1547 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001548 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001549 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001550 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1552 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001553 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001554 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001555 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001558 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001559 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001560 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001561 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001562 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001563 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001564 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1565 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001566 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1567 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1568 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1569 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1570 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1571 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1572 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1573 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1574 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001575 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001576 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001577 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001578 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001579 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001580 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001581 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001582 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1583 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001584 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1585 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001586 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1587 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1588 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001589 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001590 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1591 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1592 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001593 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001594 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001595 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001596 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001597 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001598 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001599 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001600 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001601 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1602 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1603 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1604 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001605 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1606 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001607 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001608 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001609 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001610 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001611 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001612 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001613 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001614 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001615 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001616 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1617 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001618 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001619 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001620 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001621 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001622 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001623 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001624 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1625 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001626 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1627 InOverloadResolution,
1628 SCS, CStyle)) {
1629 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1630 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001631 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1632 CStyle)) {
1633 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001634 // appropriately.
1635 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001636 } else {
1637 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001638 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001639 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001640 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001641
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001642 QualType CanonFrom;
1643 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001644 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001645 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1646 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1647 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001648 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001649 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001650 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001651 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1652 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001653 } else {
1654 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001655 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1656
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001657 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001658 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1659 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1660 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001661 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1662 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001663 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001664 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian62ac5d02010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001665 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001666 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
Guy Benyei21f18c42013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001667 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime()
1668 || (CanonFrom->isSamplerT() &&
1669 CanonFrom.getAddressSpace() != CanonTo.getAddressSpace()))) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001670 FromType = ToType;
1671 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1672 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001673 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001674 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001675
1676 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1677 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001678 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001679 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001680
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001681 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001682}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001683
1684static bool
1685IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1686 QualType &ToType,
1687 bool InOverloadResolution,
1688 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1689 bool CStyle) {
1690
1691 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1692 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1693 return false;
1694 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1695 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1696 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1697 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1698 itend = UD->field_end();
1699 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001700 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1701 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001702 ToType = it->getType();
1703 return true;
1704 }
1705 }
1706 return false;
1707}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001708
1709/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1710/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1711/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1712/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001713bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001714 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001715 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001716 if (!To) {
1717 return false;
1718 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001719
1720 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1721 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1722 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1723 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1724 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001725 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1726 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001727 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1728 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1729 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1730 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001731 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001732 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001733 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001734 }
1735
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001736 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1737 }
1738
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001739 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001740 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1741 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1742 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1743 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1744 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001745 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001746 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001747 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001748 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1749 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001750 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001751 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1752 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1753 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1754 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1755 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1756 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001757 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1758 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1759 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1760 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1761 return false;
1762
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001763 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1764 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1765 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1766 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1767 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1768 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1769 }
1770
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001771 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001772 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001773 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001774 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1775 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001776 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001777
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001778 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001779 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1780 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1781 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001782 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001783 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001784 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001785 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001786 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001787 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001788 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001789 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1790 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001791 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001792 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001793
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001794 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1795 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001796 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1797 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001798 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1799 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001800 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001801 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001802 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1803 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001804 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001805 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1806 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1807 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1808 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001809 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001810 }
1811 }
1812 }
1813
1814 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1815 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1816 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1817 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1818 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1819 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1820 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001821 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1822 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001823 using llvm::APSInt;
1824 if (From)
1825 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001826 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001827 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001828 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1829 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1830 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001831
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001832 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1833 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1834 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1835 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1836 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001837
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001838 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1839 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1840 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1841 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1842 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001843
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001844 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001845 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001846 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001847
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001848 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1849 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001850 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001851 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001852 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001853
1854 return false;
1855}
1856
1857/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1858/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1859/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001860bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001861 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1862 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001863 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1864 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001865 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1866 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1867 return true;
1868
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001869 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1870 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1871 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001872 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001873 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1874 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1875 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1876 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001877
1878 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001879 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1880 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001881 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1882 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001883 }
1884
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001885 return false;
1886}
1887
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001888/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1889///
1890/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1891/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001892/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001893bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001894 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001895 if (!FromComplex)
1896 return false;
1897
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001898 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001899 if (!ToComplex)
1900 return false;
1901
1902 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001903 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1904 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1905 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001906}
1907
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001908/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1909/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1910/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1911/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1912/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001913///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001914static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001915BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001916 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001917 ASTContext &Context,
1918 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001919 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1920 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1921 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001922
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001923 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1924 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001925 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001926
1927 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001928 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001929 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001930 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001931
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001932 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1933 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1934
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001935 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001936 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001937 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001938 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001939 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001940
1941 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1942 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001943 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1944 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001945 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1946 }
1947
1948 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001949 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1950 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001951
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001952 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1953 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1954 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001955}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001956
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001957static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001958 bool InOverloadResolution,
1959 ASTContext &Context) {
1960 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1961 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1962 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001963 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001964 return !InOverloadResolution;
1965
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001966 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1967 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1968 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001969}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001970
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001971/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1972/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1973/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1974/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1975/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1976/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001977///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001978/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1979/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1980/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1981/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1982/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1983/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001984/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1985/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1986/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001987bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001988 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001989 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001990 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001991 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001992 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1993 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001994 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001995
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001996 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1997 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001998 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001999 ConvertedType = ToType;
2000 return true;
2001 }
2002
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002003 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2004 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002005 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002006 ConvertedType = ToType;
2007 return true;
2008 }
2009 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2010 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002011 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002012 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002013 ConvertedType = ToType;
2014 return true;
2015 }
2016
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002017 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2018 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002019 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002020 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002021 ConvertedType = ToType;
2022 return true;
2023 }
2024
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002025 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002026 if (!ToTypePtr)
2027 return false;
2028
2029 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002030 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002031 ConvertedType = ToType;
2032 return true;
2033 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002034
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002035 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002036 // , including objective-c pointers.
2037 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002038 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002039 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002040 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2041 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2042 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002043 ToType, Context);
2044 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002045 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002046 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002047 if (!FromTypePtr)
2048 return false;
2049
2050 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002051
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002052 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002053 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2054 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2055 return false;
2056
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002057 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2058 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2059 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002060 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2061 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002062 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002063 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002064 ToType, Context,
2065 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002066 return true;
2067 }
2068
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002069 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002070 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002071 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2072 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2073 ToPointeeType,
2074 ToType, Context);
2075 return true;
2076 }
2077
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002078 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2079 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002080 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002081 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002082 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002083 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002084 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002085 return true;
2086 }
2087
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002088 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002089 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002090 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2091 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2092 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2093 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2094 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2095 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2096 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2097 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2098 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002099 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2100 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002101 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002102 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002103 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002104 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002105 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002106 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002107 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002108 ToType, Context);
2109 return true;
2110 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002111
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002112 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2113 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2114 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2115 ToPointeeType,
2116 ToType, Context);
2117 return true;
2118 }
2119
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002120 return false;
2121}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002122
2123/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2124static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2125 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2126
2127 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2128 if (TQs == Qs)
2129 return T;
2130
2131 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2132 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2133
2134 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2135}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002136
2137/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2138/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2139/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002141 QualType& ConvertedType,
2142 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002143 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002144 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002145
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002146 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2147 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2148
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002149 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002150 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2151 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002153 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002154
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002155 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002156 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2157 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2158 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2159 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2160 return false;
2161
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002162 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002163 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002164 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002165 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002166 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002167 return true;
2168 }
2169 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002171 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002172 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002173 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002174 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002175 return true;
2176 }
2177 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2178 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2179 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002180 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2181 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002182 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002183 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2184 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2185 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002186 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002187 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2188 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002189 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002190 return true;
2191 }
2192
2193 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2194 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2195 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2196 // complain about it.
2197 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002198 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002199 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2200 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002201 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002202 return true;
2203 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002204 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002205 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002206 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002207 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002208 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002209 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002210 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002211 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002212 // to a block pointer type.
2213 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002214 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002215 return true;
2216 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002217 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002218 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002219 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002220 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002221 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002222 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002223 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002224 return true;
2225 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002226 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002227 return false;
2228
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002229 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002230 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002231 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002232 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2233 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002234 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2235 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002236 return false;
2237
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002238 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2239 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2240 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2241 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2242 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2243 // We always complain about this conversion.
2244 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002245 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002246 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002247 return true;
2248 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002249 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2250 // as in I* to id.
2251 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2252 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2253 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2254 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002255
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002256 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002257 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002258 return true;
2259 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002260
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002261 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002262 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2263 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2264 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002265 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002266 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002267 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002268 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002269 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2270 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2271 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2272 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2273 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2274 return false;
2275
2276 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2277 // function types are obviously different.
2278 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2279 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2280 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2281 return false;
2282
2283 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2284 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2285 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2286 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2287 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2288 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2289 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2290 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2291 HasObjCConversion = true;
2292 } else {
2293 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2294 return false;
2295 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002296
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002297 // Check argument types.
2298 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2299 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2300 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2301 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2302 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2303 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2304 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2305 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2306 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2307 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2308 HasObjCConversion = true;
2309 } else {
2310 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2311 return false;
2312 }
2313 }
2314
2315 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2316 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2317 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002318 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002319 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2320 return true;
2321 }
2322 }
2323
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002324 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002325}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002326
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002327/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2328/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2329///
2330/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2331///
2332/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2333///
2334/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2335/// this conversion.
2336bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2337 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002338 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002339 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2340 return false;
2341
2342 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2343 QualType ToPointee;
2344 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2345 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2346 else
2347 return false;
2348
2349 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2350 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2351 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002352 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002353 return false;
2354
2355 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2356 QualType FromPointee;
2357 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2358 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2359 else
2360 return false;
2361
2362 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2363 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2364 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2365 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2366 return false;
2367
2368 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2369 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2370 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2371 return false;
2372
2373 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2374 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2375 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2376 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2377
2378 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2379 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2380 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2381 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2382 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2383 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2384 IncompatibleObjC))
2385 return false;
2386
2387 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2388 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2389 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2390 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2391 return true;
2392}
2393
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002394bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2395 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2396 QualType ToPointeeType;
2397 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2398 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2399 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2400 else
2401 return false;
2402
2403 QualType FromPointeeType;
2404 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2405 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2406 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2407 else
2408 return false;
2409 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2410 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2411 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2412
2413 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2414 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2415 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2416 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2417
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002418 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2419 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002420
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002421 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002422 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002423
2424 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2425 // function types are obviously different.
2426 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2427 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2428 return false;
2429
2430 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2431 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2432 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2433 return false;
2434
2435 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002436 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2437 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002438 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2439 } else {
2440 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2441 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002442 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002443 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2444 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2445
2446 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2447 // OK exact match.
2448 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2449 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2450 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2451 return false;
2452 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2453 }
2454 else
2455 return false;
2456 }
2457
2458 // Check argument types.
2459 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2460 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2461 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2462 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2463 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2464 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2465 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2466 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2467 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2468 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2469 return false;
2470 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2471 } else
2472 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2473 return false;
2474 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002475 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2476 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2477 ToFunctionType))
2478 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002479
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002480 ConvertedType = ToType;
2481 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002482}
2483
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002484enum {
2485 ft_default,
2486 ft_different_class,
2487 ft_parameter_arity,
2488 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2489 ft_return_type,
2490 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2491};
2492
2493/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2494/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2495/// parameter types, and different return types.
2496void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2497 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002498 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2499 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2500 PDiag << ft_default;
2501 return;
2502 }
2503
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002504 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2505 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2506 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2507 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2508 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2509 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2510 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2511 return;
2512 }
2513 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2514 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002515 }
2516
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002517 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2518 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2519 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2520 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2521
2522 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002523 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2524 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2525
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002526 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2527 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2528 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2529 PDiag << ft_default;
2530 return;
2531 }
2532
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002533 // No extra info for same types.
2534 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2535 PDiag << ft_default;
2536 return;
2537 }
2538
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002539 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2540 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2541
2542 // Both types need to be function types.
2543 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2544 PDiag << ft_default;
2545 return;
2546 }
2547
2548 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2549 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2550 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2551 return;
2552 }
2553
2554 // Handle different parameter types.
2555 unsigned ArgPos;
2556 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2557 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2558 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2559 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2560 return;
2561 }
2562
2563 // Handle different return type.
2564 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2565 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2566 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2567 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2568 return;
2569 }
2570
2571 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2572 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2573 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2574 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2575 return;
2576 }
2577
2578 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2579 PDiag << ft_default;
2580}
2581
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002582/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002583/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002584/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2585/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Sylvestre Ledrubed28ac2012-07-23 08:59:39 +00002586/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the parameter index
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002587/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002588bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002589 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2590 unsigned *ArgPos) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002591 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002592 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2593 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2594 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2595 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2596 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2597 return false;
2598 }
2599 }
2600 return true;
2601 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002602
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002603 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2604 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2605 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2606 QualType ToType = (*O);
2607 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002608 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002609 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2610 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002611 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2612 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2613 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2614 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002615 continue;
2616 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002617 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2618 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002619 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002620 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002621 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2622 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2623 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002624 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002625 }
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002626 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002627 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002628 }
2629 }
2630 return true;
2631}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002632
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002633/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2634/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002635/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002636/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2637/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2638/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002639bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002640 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002641 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002642 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002643 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002644 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002645
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002646 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2647
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002648 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2649 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2650 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2651 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2652 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2653 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2654 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2655 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2656 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2657 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2658 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002659 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2660 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002661 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2662 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002663
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002664 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2665 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002666 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2667 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002668 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2669 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002670 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002671 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002672 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002673
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002674 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002675 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002676 }
2677 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002678 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2679 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2680 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2681 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002682 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2683 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2684 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002685 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002686 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002687 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2688 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2689 } else {
2690 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002691 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002692 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2693 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2694 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002695 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002696
2697 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2698 // reasons.
2699 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2700 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2701
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002702 return false;
2703}
2704
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002705/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2706/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2707/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2708/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2709/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2710bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002711 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002712 bool InOverloadResolution,
2713 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002714 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002715 if (!ToTypePtr)
2716 return false;
2717
2718 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002719 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2720 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2721 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002722 ConvertedType = ToType;
2723 return true;
2724 }
2725
2726 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002727 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002728 if (!FromTypePtr)
2729 return false;
2730
2731 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2732 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2733 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2734 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002735
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002736 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002737 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002738 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002739 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2740 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2741 return true;
2742 }
2743
2744 return false;
2745}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002746
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002747/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2748/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002749/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002750/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2751/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2752/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002753bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002754 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002755 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002756 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002757 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002758 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002759 if (!FromPtrType) {
2760 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002761 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002762 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002763 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002764 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002765 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002766 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002767
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002768 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002769 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2770 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002771
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002772 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2773 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002774
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002775 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2776 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2777 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002778
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002779 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002780 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002781 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2782 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2783 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2784 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002785
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002786 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2787 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002788 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2789 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2790 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2791 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002792 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002793
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002794 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002795 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2796 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2797 << From->getSourceRange();
2798 return true;
2799 }
2800
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002801 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002802 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2803 Paths.front(),
2804 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002805
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002806 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002807 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002808 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002809 return false;
2810}
2811
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002812/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2813/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2814/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002815///
2816/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2817/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2818/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002819bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002820Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002821 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002822 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2823 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002824 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2825
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002826 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2827 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002828 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002829 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002830
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002831 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2832 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2833 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2834 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002835 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002836 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002837 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2838 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2839 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002840 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002841 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2842 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002843 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002844
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002845 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2846 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2847
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002848 // Objective-C ARC:
2849 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2850 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2851 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2852 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2853 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2854 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2855 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2856 } else {
2857 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2858 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2859 return false;
2860 }
2861 }
2862
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002863 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2864 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2865 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2866 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2867 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2868 }
2869
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002870 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2871 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002872 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002873 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002874
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002875 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2876 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002877 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002878 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002879 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002880
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002881 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2882 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002883 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002884 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002885 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002886
2887 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2888 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2889 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2890 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2891 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002892 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002893}
2894
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002895/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2896/// atomic type.
2897///
2898/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2899/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002900static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2901 bool InOverloadResolution,
2902 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2903 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002904 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2905 if (!ToAtomic)
2906 return false;
2907
2908 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2909 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2910 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2911 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2912 return false;
2913
2914 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2915 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2916 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2917 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2918 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2919 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2920 return true;
2921}
2922
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002923static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2924 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2925 QualType Type) {
2926 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2927 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2928 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2929 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2930 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2931 return true;
2932 }
2933 return false;
2934}
2935
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002936static OverloadingResult
2937IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2938 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2939 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2940 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2941 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002942 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2943 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002944 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2945 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2946 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2947
2948 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2949 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2950 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2951 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2952 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2953 Constructor
2954 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2955 else
2956 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2957
2958 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2959 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2960 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2961 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002962 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2963 // suppress conversions.
2964 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2965 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002966 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2967 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2968 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002969 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002970 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002971 else
2972 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002973 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002974 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002975 }
2976 }
2977
2978 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2979
2980 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2981 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2982 case OR_Success: {
2983 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2984 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002985 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2986 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2987 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2988 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2989 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2990 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2991 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2992 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2993 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2994 return OR_Success;
2995 }
2996
2997 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2998 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2999 case OR_Deleted:
3000 return OR_Deleted;
3001 case OR_Ambiguous:
3002 return OR_Ambiguous;
3003 }
3004
3005 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3006}
3007
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003008/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3009/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3010/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3011/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3012/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3013/// false and User is unspecified.
3014///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003015/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3016/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3017/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003018static OverloadingResult
3019IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003020 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3021 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003022 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003023 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3024 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3025
3026 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3027 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003028 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003029 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3030 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3031 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3032 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3033 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3034 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3035 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3036 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003037 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003038 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003039 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003040 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3041
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003042 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003043 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3044 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3045 // to try to recover.
3046 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003047 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3048 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3049 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003050
3051 Expr **Args = &From;
3052 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3053 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003054 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003055 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
3056 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3057 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3058 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3059 return Result;
3060 // Never mind.
3061 CandidateSet.clear();
3062
3063 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3064 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003065 Args = InitList->getInits();
3066 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3067 ListInitializing = true;
3068 }
3069
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003070 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3071 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003072 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003073 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3074 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3075
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003076 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3077 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3078 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003079 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003080 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003081 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003082 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3083 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003084 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003085
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003086 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3087 if (ListInitializing)
3088 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3089 else
3090 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3091 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003092 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3093 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3094 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3095 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3096 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3097 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003098 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3099 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003100 }
3101 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003102 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003103 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3104 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003105 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003106 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003107 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003108 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3109 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003110 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003111 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003112 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003113 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003114 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003115 }
3116 }
3117
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003118 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003119 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003120 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003121 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003122 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003123 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003125 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3126 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003127 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3128 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3129 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3130 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3131 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003132 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3133 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003134 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3135 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3136 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3137
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003138 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3139 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003140 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3141 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003142 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003143 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003144
3145 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3146 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003147 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3148 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3149 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003150 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003151 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3152 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003153 }
3154 }
3155 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003156 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003157
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003158 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3159
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003160 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003161 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003162 case OR_Success:
3163 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3164 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3165 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3166 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3167 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3168 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3169 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3170 // the argument of the constructor.
3171 //
3172 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003173 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3174 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3175 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3176 } else {
3177 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3178 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3179 else {
3180 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3181 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3182 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003183 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003184 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003185 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003186 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003187 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3188 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3189 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3190 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003191 }
3192 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003193 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3194 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3195 //
3196 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3197 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3198 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3199 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3200 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003201 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003202 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003203 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003204 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003205
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003206 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3207 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3208 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3209 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3210 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3211 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3212 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3213 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3214 // 13.3.3.1).
3215 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3216 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003217 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003218 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003219
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003220 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3221 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3222 case OR_Deleted:
3223 // No conversion here! We're done.
3224 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003225
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003226 case OR_Ambiguous:
3227 return OR_Ambiguous;
3228 }
3229
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003230 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003231}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003232
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003233bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003234Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003235 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003236 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003237 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003238 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003239 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003240 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003241 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003242 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3243 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3244 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003245 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003246 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3247 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3248 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003249 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003250 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003251 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003252}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003253
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003254/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3255/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3256/// is possible.
3257static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3258compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3259 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3260 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003261 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003262 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3263
3264 // Objective-C++:
3265 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3266 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3267 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3268 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3269 // to keep code working.
3270 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3271 if (!Conv1)
3272 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3273
3274 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3275 if (!Conv2)
3276 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3277
3278 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3279 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3280 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3281 if (Block1 != Block2)
3282 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3283 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3284 }
3285
3286 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3287}
3288
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003289/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3290/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3291/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003292static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3293CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3294 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3295 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003296{
3297 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3298 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3299 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3300 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3301 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3302 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3303 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3304 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003305 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003306 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3307 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3308 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3309 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3310 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003311 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3312 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003313 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003314 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003315
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003316 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3317 // the same kind.
3318 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3319 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3320
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003321 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3322 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3323
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003324 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3325 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3326 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003327 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003328 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3329 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003330 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003331 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3332 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3333 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3334 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3335 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3336 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003337 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003338 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003339 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3340 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3341 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003342 else
3343 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3344 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3345 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003346 }
3347
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003348 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3349 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3350 // for some X and L2 does not.
3351 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003352 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003353 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3354 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003355 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3356 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3357 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3358 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3359 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3360 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003361 }
3362
3363 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003364}
3365
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003366static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3367 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3368 Qualifiers Quals;
3369 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003370 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003371 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003372
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003373 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3374}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003375
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003376// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3377// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3378static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3379compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3380 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3381 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3382 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3383 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3384
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003385 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003386 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003387 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3388 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3389 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3390 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003391
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003392 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3393 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3394 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3395 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3396 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3397 else
3398 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003399 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003400 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3401
3402 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3403 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3404 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3405 }
3406
3407 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3408 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3409 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3410 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3411
3412 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3413 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3414 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3415 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003416
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003417 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3418}
3419
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003420/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3421/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3422static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3423 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3424 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3425 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3426 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003427 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003428 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003429 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003430 // reference*.
3431 //
3432 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3433 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3434 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3435 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3436 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003437 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3438 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3439 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003440
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003441 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3442 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3443 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3444 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3445}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003446
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003447/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3448/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3449/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003450static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3451CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3452 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3453 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003454{
3455 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3456 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3457
3458 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3459 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3460 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3461 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3462 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003463 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003464 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003465 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003466
3467 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3468 // defined below), or, if not that,
3469 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3470 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3471 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3472 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3473 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3474 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003475
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003476 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3477 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3478 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003479
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003480 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3481 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3482 // that is such a conversion.
3483 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3484 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3485 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3486 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3487
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003488 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3489 //
3490 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003491 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3492 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3493 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003494 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003495 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003496 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003497 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003498 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3499 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3500 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003501 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3502 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003503 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3504 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3505 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003506 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003507 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003508 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003509 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3510 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003511 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3512 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3513 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003514 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3515 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003516
3517 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3518 // conversion, if we need to.
3519 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003520 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003521 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003522 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003523
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003524 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3525 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003526
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003527 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003528 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003529 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003530 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3531
3532 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3533 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003534 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3535 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3536 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3537 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3538 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3539 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3540 FromObjCPtr2);
3541 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3542 FromObjCPtr1);
3543 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3544 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3545 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3546 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003547 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003548 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003549
3550 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3551 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003552 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003553 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003554 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003555
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003556 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003557 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3558 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3559 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3560 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3561 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003562
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003563 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3564 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3565 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3566 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3567 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3568 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003569 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3570 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003571 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3572 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003573 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003574 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3575 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003576 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003577 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3578 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3579 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3580 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3581 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3582 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3583 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3584 }
3585
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003586 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3587 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003588 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003589 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003590 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003591 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003592 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3593 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3594 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003595 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003596 }
3597 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003598
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003599 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3600 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3601 // is between types of the same size.
3602 // For example:
3603 // void f(float);
3604 // void f(int);
3605 // int main {
3606 // long a;
3607 // f(a);
3608 // }
3609 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3610 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003611 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003612 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3613 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3614 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3615 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3616 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3617
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003618 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3619}
3620
3621/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3622/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3624ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003625CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3626 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3627 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003628 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003629 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3630 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3631 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3632 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3633 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3634 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3635 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3636 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3637
3638 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3639 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003640 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3641 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003642 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3643 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003644 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003645 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3646 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003647
3648 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3649 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003650 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3652
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003653 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3654 // for comparison.
3655 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003656 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003657 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003658 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003659
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003660 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003661 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003662
3663 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3664 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3665 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3666 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3667 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3668 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3669 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3670 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3671 }
3672
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003673 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003674 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3675 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3676 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003677 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003678 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3679 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3680 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3681 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3682 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3683 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3684 // about how the sequences rank.
3685 ;
3686 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3687 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3688 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3689 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3690 // qualifiers.
3691 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003692
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003693 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3694 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3695 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3696 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3697 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3698 // qualifiers.
3699 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003700
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003701 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3702 } else {
3703 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3705 }
3706
3707 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003708 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003709 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003710 }
3711
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003712 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3713 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3714 switch (Result) {
3715 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003716 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003717 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3718 break;
3719
3720 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3721 break;
3722
3723 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003724 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003725 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3726 break;
3727 }
3728
3729 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003730}
3731
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003732/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3733/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003734/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3735/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3736/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003737ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003738CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3739 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3740 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003741 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003742 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003743 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003744 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003745
3746 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3747 // conversion, if we need to.
3748 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003749 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003750 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003751 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003752
3753 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003754 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3755 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3756 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3757 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003758
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003759 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003760 //
3761 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3762 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003763 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003764 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003765 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003766 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3767 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3768 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3769 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003770 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003771 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003772 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003773 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003774 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003775 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003776 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003777 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003778
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003779 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003780 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003781 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003782 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003783 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003784 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3785 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003786
3787 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3788 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003789 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003790 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003791 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003792 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003793 }
3794 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3795 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3796 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3797 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3798 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3799 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3800 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3801 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3802 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3803 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3804
3805 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3806 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3807 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3808 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3809 // Objective-C pointer types.
3810 bool FromAssignLeft
3811 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3812 bool FromAssignRight
3813 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3814 bool ToAssignLeft
3815 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3816 bool ToAssignRight
3817 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3818
3819 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3820 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3821 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3822 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3823 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3824 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3825 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3827
3828 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3829 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3830 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3831 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3832 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3833 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3834
3835 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3836 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3837 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3838 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3839 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3840 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3841 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3842 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3843
3844 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3845 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3846 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3847 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3848 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3849 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003850
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003851 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3852 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3853 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3854 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3855 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3856 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3857
3858 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3859 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3860 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3861 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3862 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003863 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003864 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003865
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003866 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003867 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3868 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3869 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003870 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003871 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003872 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003873 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003874 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003875 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003876 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003877 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3878 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3879 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3880 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3881 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3882 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3883 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3884 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3885 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003886 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003887 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003888 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003889 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003890 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003891 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3892 }
3893 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3894 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003895 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003896 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003897 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003898 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3899 }
3900 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003901
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003902 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003903 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003904 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3905 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3906 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003907 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3908 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3909 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003910 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003911 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003912 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3913 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003914
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003915 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003916 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3917 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3918 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003919 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3920 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3921 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003922 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003923 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003924 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3925 }
3926 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003927
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003928 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3929}
3930
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003931/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3932/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3933/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3934/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3935/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3936/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3937/// type being initialized.
3938Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3939Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3940 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003941 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003942 bool &ObjCConversion,
3943 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003944 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3945 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3946 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3947
3948 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3949 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3950 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3951 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3952 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3953
3954 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3955 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3956 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3957 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003958 DerivedToBase = false;
3959 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003960 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003961 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3962 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003963 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003964 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3965 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003966 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3967 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3968 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3969 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003970 else
3971 return Ref_Incompatible;
3972
3973 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3974 // least).
3975
3976 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3977 // for comparison.
3978 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3979 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3980 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3981 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3982
3983 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3984 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3985 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3986 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3987 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3988 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3989 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003990 //
3991 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3992 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3993 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3994 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003995 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3996 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3997 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3998 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3999 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4000 }
4001
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004002 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004003 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004004 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004005 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4006 else
4007 return Ref_Related;
4008}
4009
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004010/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004011/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4012static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004013FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4014 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4015 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4016 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004017 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4018 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4019 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4020
4021 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004022 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4023 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4024 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4025 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4026 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004027 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4028 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4029 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4030 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4031
4032 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4033 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4034 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4035 if (ConvTemplate)
4036 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4037 else
4038 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4039
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004040 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004041 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4042 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4043 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004044
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004045 if (AllowRvalues) {
4046 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4047 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004048 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004049
4050 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4051 // functions that return lvalues.
4052 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4053 const ReferenceType *RefType
4054 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4055 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4056 continue;
4057 }
4058
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004059 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004060 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4061 DeclLoc,
4062 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4063 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4064 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004065 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004066 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004067 continue;
4068 } else {
4069 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4070 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4071 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4072
4073 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4074 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4075 if (!RefType ||
4076 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4077 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4078 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004079 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004080
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004081 if (ConvTemplate)
4082 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004083 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004084 else
4085 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004086 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004087 }
4088
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004089 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4090
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004091 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004092 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004093 case OR_Success:
4094 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4095 //
4096 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4097 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4098 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4099 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4100 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4101 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4102 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4103 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4104 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4105 return false;
4106
4107 ICS.setUserDefined();
4108 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4109 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004110 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004111 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004112 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004113 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4114 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4115 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4116 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4117 return true;
4118
4119 case OR_Ambiguous:
4120 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4121 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4122 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4123 if (Cand->Viable)
4124 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4125 return true;
4126
4127 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4128 case OR_Deleted:
4129 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4130 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4131 return false;
4132 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004133
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004134 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004135}
4136
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004137/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4138/// initialization.
4139static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004140TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004141 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4142 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004143 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004144 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4145
4146 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4147 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4148 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4149
4150 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4151 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4152
4153 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4154 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4155 // type of the resulting function.
4156 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4157 DeclAccessPair Found;
4158 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4159 false, Found))
4160 T2 = Fn->getType();
4161 }
4162
4163 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4164 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4165 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004166 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004167 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004168 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004169 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004170 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004171 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004172
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004173
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004174 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004175 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4176 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4177
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004178 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004179 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004180 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4181 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4182 //
4183 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4184 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4185 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004186 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004187 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4188 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4189 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4190 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4191 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4192 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4193 ICS.setStandard();
4194 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004195 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4196 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4197 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004198 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4199 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4200 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4201 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4202 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4203 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4204 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004205 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4206 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4207 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004208 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004209 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004210 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004211
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004212 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4213 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4214 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4215 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004216 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004217 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004218
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004219 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4220 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4221 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4222 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4223 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4224 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4225 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4226 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004227 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004228 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004229 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4230 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4231 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004232 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004233 }
4234 }
4235
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004236 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4237 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004238 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004239 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004240 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4241 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4242 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4243 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4244 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4245 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4246 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004247 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4248 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004249 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004250 return ICS;
4251
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004252 // -- If the initializer expression
4253 //
4254 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004255 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004256 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4257 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4258 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4259 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4260 ICS.setStandard();
4261 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004262 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004263 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4264 : ICK_Identity;
4265 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4266 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4267 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4268 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4269 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4270 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4271 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4272 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4273 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4274 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4275 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004276 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004277 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004278 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004279 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4280 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004281 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004282 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004283 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004284 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004285 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004286 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004287
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004288 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4289 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4291 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004292 // "cv3 T3",
4293 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004294 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004295 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004296 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004297 // class subobject).
4298 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004299 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004300 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4301 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4302 AllowExplicit)) {
4303 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4304 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4305 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4306 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004307 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004308 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4309 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4310
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004311 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004312 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004313
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004314 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4315 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4316 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4317 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4318 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4319 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4320 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4321 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4322 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4323 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4324 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4325 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004326 //
4327 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4328 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4329 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4330 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4331 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4332 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4333 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4334 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4335 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4336 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004337 }
4338
4339 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4340 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4341 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4342 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4343 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4344 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4345 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4346 return ICS;
4347
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004348 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4349 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4350 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4351 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4352 return ICS;
4353
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004354 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004355 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4356 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4357 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4358 // underlying type of the reference according to
4359 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4360 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4361 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4362 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4363 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004364 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4365 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004366 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004367 /*CStyle=*/false,
4368 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004369
4370 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4371 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4372 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004373 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4374 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4375 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004376 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004377 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004378 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004379 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4380 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4381 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4382 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4383 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4384 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4385 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4386 DeclType);
4387 return ICS;
4388 }
4389 }
4390 }
4391
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004392 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004393 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4394 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4395 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4396 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4397 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004398 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004399
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004400 return ICS;
4401}
4402
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004403static ImplicitConversionSequence
4404TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4405 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4406 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004407 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4408 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004409
4410/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4411/// initializer list From.
4412static ImplicitConversionSequence
4413TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4414 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4415 bool InOverloadResolution,
4416 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4417 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4418 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4419 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4420
4421 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4422 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004423 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004424
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004425 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004426 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004427 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004428 return Result;
4429
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004430 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4431 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4432 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4433 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4434 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004435 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004436 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004437 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004438 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004439 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004440 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004441 if (!X.isNull()) {
4442 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4443 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4444 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4445 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4446 InOverloadResolution,
4447 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4448 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4449 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4450 Result = ICS;
4451 break;
4452 }
4453 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4454 if (Result.isBad() ||
4455 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4456 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4457 Result = ICS;
4458 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004459
4460 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4461 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4462 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4463 Result.setStandard();
4464 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4465 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4466 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4467 }
4468
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004469 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004470 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004471 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004472 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004473
4474 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4475 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4476 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4477 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4478 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4479 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004480 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4481 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4482 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4483 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4484 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4485 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4486 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004487 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004488 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004489
4490 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4491 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4492 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4493 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004494 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004495 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4496 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4497 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4498 InitializedEntity Entity =
4499 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4500 /*Consumed=*/false);
4501 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4502 Result.setUserDefined();
4503 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4504 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4505 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4506 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4507
4508 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4509 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4510 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004511 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004512 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004513 return Result;
4514 }
4515
4516 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4517 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004518 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4519 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4520 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4521 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4522
4523 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4524
4525 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4526 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4527 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4528 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4529
4530 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4531
4532 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4533 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4534 // type of the resulting function.
4535 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4536 DeclAccessPair Found;
4537 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4538 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4539 T2 = Fn->getType();
4540 }
4541
4542 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4543 bool dummy1 = false;
4544 bool dummy2 = false;
4545 bool dummy3 = false;
4546 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4547 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4548 dummy2, dummy3);
4549
4550 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4551 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4552 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4553 SuppressUserConversions,
4554 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4555 }
4556
4557 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4558 // initializer list.
4559 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4560 InOverloadResolution,
4561 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4562 if (Result.isFailure())
4563 return Result;
4564 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4565 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4566
4567 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4568 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4569 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4570 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4571 Result.UserDefined.After;
4572 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4573 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4574 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4575 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4576 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4577 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4578 } else
4579 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4580 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004581 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004582 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004583
4584 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4585 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4586 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4587 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4588 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4589 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004590 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4591 if (NumInits == 1)
4592 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4593 SuppressUserConversions,
4594 InOverloadResolution,
4595 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4596 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4597 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4598 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4599 Result.setStandard();
4600 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004601 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4602 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004603 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004604 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004605 return Result;
4606 }
4607
4608 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4609 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4610 return Result;
4611}
4612
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004613/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4614/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4615/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4616/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004617/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004618/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004619static ImplicitConversionSequence
4620TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004621 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004622 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004623 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4624 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004625 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4626 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4627 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4628
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004629 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004630 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004631 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4632 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004633 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004634
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004635 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4636 SuppressUserConversions,
4637 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004638 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004639 /*CStyle=*/false,
4640 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004641}
4642
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004643static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4644 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4645 Sema &S,
4646 SourceLocation Loc,
4647 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4648 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4649 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4650 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4651
4652 return !ICS.isBad();
4653}
4654
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004655/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4656/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4657/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004658static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004659TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004660 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004661 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4662 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4663 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004664 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4665 // const volatile object.
4666 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4667 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004668 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004669
4670 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4671 // to exit early.
4672 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004673
4674 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004675 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004676 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4677
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004678 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4679 // better have an lvalue.
4680 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4681 }
4682
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004683 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004684
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004685 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004686 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004687 // parameter is
4688 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004689 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4690 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4691 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004692 // ref-qualifier
4693 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004694 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004695 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4696 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004697 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004698 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004699 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4700 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4701 // non-constant references.
4702
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004703 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004704 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004705 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004706 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004707 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004708 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004709 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004710 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004711 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004712
4713 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4714 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004715 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004716 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4717 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4718 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004719 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004720 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004721 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004722 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4723 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004724 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004725 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004726
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004727 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4728 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4729 case RQ_None:
4730 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4731 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004732
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004733 case RQ_LValue:
4734 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4735 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004736 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004737 ImplicitParamType);
4738 return ICS;
4739 }
4740 break;
4741
4742 case RQ_RValue:
4743 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4744 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004745 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004746 ImplicitParamType);
4747 return ICS;
4748 }
4749 break;
4750 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004751
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004752 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004753 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004754 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4755 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004756 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004757 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004758 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4759 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004760 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004761 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004762 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4763 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4764 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004765 return ICS;
4766}
4767
4768/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4769/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4770/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004771ExprResult
4772Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004773 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004774 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004775 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004776 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004777 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004778 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004779
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004780 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004781 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004782 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4783 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004784 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004785 } else {
4786 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4787 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004788 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004789 }
4790
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004791 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4792 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004793 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004794 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4795 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004796 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4797 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4798 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4799 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4800 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4801 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004802 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004803 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4804 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4805 << From->getSourceRange();
4806 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4807 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004808 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004809 }
4810 }
4811
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004812 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004813 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004814 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004815 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004816
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004817 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4818 ExprResult FromRes =
4819 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4820 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4821 return ExprError();
4822 From = FromRes.take();
4823 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004824
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004825 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004826 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004827 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004828 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004829}
4830
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004831/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4832/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004833static ImplicitConversionSequence
4834TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004835 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004836 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004837 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4838 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004840 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004841 /*CStyle=*/false,
4842 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004843}
4844
4845/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4846/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004847ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004848 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4849 return ExprError();
4850
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004851 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004852 if (!ICS.isBad())
4853 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004854
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004855 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004856 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004857 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004858 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004859 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004860}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004861
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004862/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4863/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4864/// is acceptable.
4865static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4866 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4867 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4868 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4869 // conversions are fine.
4870 switch (SCS.Second) {
4871 case ICK_Identity:
4872 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4873 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4874 return true;
4875
4876 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004877 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4878 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4879 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4880 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4881 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4882
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004883 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4884 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4885 return false;
4886
4887 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4888 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4889 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4890 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4891 case ICK_Qualification:
4892 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4893 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4894 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4895 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4896 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4897 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4898 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4899 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4900 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4901 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4902 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4903 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4904 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4905 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4906
4907 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4908 break;
4909 }
4910
4911 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4912}
4913
4914/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4915/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4916/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4917ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4918 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4919 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004920 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004921 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4922
4923 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4924 return ExprError();
4925
4926 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4927 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4928 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4929 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4930 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4931 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4932 // narrowing conversions.
4933 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4934 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4935 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4936 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4937 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4938 /*CStyle=*/false,
4939 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4940 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4941 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4942 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4943 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004944 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004945 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4946 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4947 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4948 break;
4949 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4950 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4951 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4952 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004953 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004954 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4955 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4956 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4957 break;
4958 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4959 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4960 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004961 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004962 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4963 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4964 return ExprError();
4965
4966 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4967 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4968 }
4969
4970 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4971 if (Result.isInvalid())
4972 return Result;
4973
4974 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4975 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004976 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004977 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4978 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004979 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4980 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4981 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4982 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4983 break;
4984
4985 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004986 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4987 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4988 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004989 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004990 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004991 break;
4992
4993 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004994 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4995 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4996 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004997 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
4998 break;
4999 }
5000
5001 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005002 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005003 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5004 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5005
5006 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
5007 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5008 // the AST.
5009 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005010 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005011 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005012
5013 if (Notes.empty()) {
5014 // It's a constant expression.
5015 return Result;
5016 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005017 }
5018
5019 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5020 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5021 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5022 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5023 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005024 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005025 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5026 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5027 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5028 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005029 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005030}
5031
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005032/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5033/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5034/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5035static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5036 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5037 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5038 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5039 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5040 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005041}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005042
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005043/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5044/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5045static ImplicitConversionSequence
5046TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5047 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5048 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5049 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5050 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5051 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5052 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5053 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5054 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5055 /*CStyle=*/false,
5056 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
5057
5058 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5059 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5060 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5061 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5062 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5063 break;
5064
5065 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5066 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5067 break;
5068
5069 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5070 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5071 break;
5072 }
5073
5074 return ICS;
5075}
5076
5077/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5078/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5079ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005080 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5081 return ExprError();
5082
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005083 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005084 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5085 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005086 if (!ICS.isBad())
5087 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005088 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005089}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005090
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005091/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5092/// type of a permitted flavor.
5093static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
5094 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5095 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5096}
5097
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005098/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005099/// enumeration type.
5100///
5101/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
5102/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
5103/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5104///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005105/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5106/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005107///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005108/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005109///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005110/// \param Diagnoser Used to output any diagnostics.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005111///
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005112/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
5113/// enumerations should be considered.
5114///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005115/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5116/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005117ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005118Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005119 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005120 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005121 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5122 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005123 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005124
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005125 // Process placeholders immediately.
5126 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5127 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5128 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
5129 From = result.take();
5130 }
5131
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005132 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
5133 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005134 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005135 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005136
5137 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5138
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005139 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005140 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
5141 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005142 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005143 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
5144 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005145 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005146 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005147
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005148 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005149 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005150 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser;
5151 Expr *From;
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005152
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005153 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From)
5154 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {}
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005155
5156 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005157 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005158 }
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005159 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005160
5161 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005162 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005163
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005164 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5165 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
5166 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005167 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
5168 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005169 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005170
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005171 bool HadMultipleCandidates
5172 = (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005173
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005174 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
5175 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005176 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005177 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
5178 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
5179 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
5180 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005181 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5182 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5183 else
5184 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5185 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005186 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005187 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005188
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005189 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5190 case 0:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005191 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005192 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5193 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5194 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005195
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005196 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5197 // conversion; use it.
5198 QualType ConvTy
5199 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5200 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor8987b232011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005201 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005202
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005203 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005204 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5205 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5206 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5207 ")");
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005208 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005209
5210 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005211 // explicit conversion function.
5212 if (isSFINAEContext())
5213 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005214
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005215 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005216 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5217 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005218 if (Result.isInvalid())
5219 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005220 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5221 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5222 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5223 Result.get(), 0,
5224 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005225 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005226
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005227 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5228 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005229
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005230 case 1: {
5231 // Apply this conversion.
5232 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5233 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005234
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005235 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5236 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5237 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005238 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005239 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) {
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005240 if (isSFINAEContext())
5241 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005242
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005243 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5244 << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005245 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005246
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005247 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5248 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005249 if (Result.isInvalid())
5250 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005251 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5252 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5253 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5254 Result.get(), 0,
5255 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005256 break;
5257 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005258
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005259 default:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005260 if (Diagnoser.Suppress)
5261 return ExprError();
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005262
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005263 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005264 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5265 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5266 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5267 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005268 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005269 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005270 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005271 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005272
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005273 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005274 !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
5275 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType())
5276 << From->getSourceRange();
5277 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005278
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005279 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005280}
5281
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005282/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005283/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5284/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5285/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005286///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005287/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005288/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5289/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005290void
5291Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005292 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005293 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005294 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005295 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005296 bool PartialOverloading,
5297 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005298 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005299 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005300 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005301 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005302 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005303
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005304 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005305 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5306 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5307 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5308 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5309 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005310 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5311 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5312 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005313 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005314 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005315 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005316 return;
5317 }
5318 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5319 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005320 }
5321
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005322 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005323 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005324
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005325 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005326 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005327
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005328 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5329 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5330 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5331 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5332 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005333 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005334 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005335 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5336 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005337 return;
5338 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005339
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005340 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005341 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005342 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005343 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005344 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005345 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005346 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005347 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005348
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005349 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5350
5351 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5352 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5353 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005354 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005355 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005356 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005357 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005358 return;
5359 }
5360
5361 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5362 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5363 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5364 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5365 // exactly m parameters.
5366 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005367 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005368 // Not enough arguments.
5369 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005370 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005371 return;
5372 }
5373
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005374 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005375 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005376 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5377 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5378 Candidate.Viable = false;
5379 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5380 return;
5381 }
5382
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005383 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5384 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005385 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005386 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5387 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5388 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5389 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5390 // parameter of F.
5391 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005392 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005393 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005394 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005395 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5396 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005397 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005398 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005399 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5400 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005401 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005402 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005403 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005404 } else {
5405 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5406 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5407 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005408 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005409 }
5410 }
5411}
5412
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005413/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5414/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005415void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005416 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005417 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005418 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5419 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005420 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005421 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5422 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005423 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005424 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005425 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005426 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005427 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5428 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005429 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005430 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005431 SuppressUserConversions);
5432 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005433 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005434 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5435 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005436 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005437 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005438 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005439 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005440 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5441 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005442 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005443 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005444 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005445 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005446 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005447 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005448}
5449
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005450/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5451/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005452void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005453 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005454 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005455 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5456 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005457 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005458 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005459 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005460
5461 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5462 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005463
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005464 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5465 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5466 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005467 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5468 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005469 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5470 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005471 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005472 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005473 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005474 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5475 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005476 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005477 }
5478}
5479
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005480/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5481/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5482/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5483/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5484/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5485/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005486/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005487void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005488Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005489 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005490 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005491 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005492 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005493 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005494 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005495 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005496 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005497 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5498 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005499
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005500 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5501 return;
5502
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005503 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005504 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005505
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005506 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005507 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005508 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005509 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005510 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005511 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005512 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005513
5514 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5515
5516 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5517 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5518 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005519 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005520 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005521 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005522 return;
5523 }
5524
5525 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5526 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5527 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5528 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5529 // exactly m parameters.
5530 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005531 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005532 // Not enough arguments.
5533 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005534 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005535 return;
5536 }
5537
5538 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005539
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005540 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005541 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5542 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5543 else {
5544 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5545 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005546 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005547 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5548 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005549 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005550 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005551 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005552 return;
5553 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005554 }
5555
5556 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5557 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005558 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005559 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5560 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5561 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5562 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5563 // parameter of F.
5564 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005565 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005566 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005567 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005568 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5569 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005570 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005571 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005572 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005573 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005574 break;
5575 }
5576 } else {
5577 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5578 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5579 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005580 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005581 }
5582 }
5583}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005584
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005585/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5586/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5587/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005588void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005589Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005590 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005591 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005592 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005593 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005594 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005595 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005596 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005597 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005598 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5599 return;
5600
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005601 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005602 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005603 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005604 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005605 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5606 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5607 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5608 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5609 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005610 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005611 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5612 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005613 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5614 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005615 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005616 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5617 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5618 Candidate.Viable = false;
5619 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5620 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5621 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005622 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005623 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005624 Info);
5625 return;
5626 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005627
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005628 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5629 // deduction as a candidate.
5630 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005631 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005632 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005633 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005634 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5635 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005636}
5637
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005638/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5639/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5640/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005641void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005642Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005643 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005644 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005645 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005646 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005647 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005648 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5649 return;
5650
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005651 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005652 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005653 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005654 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005655 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5656 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5657 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5658 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5659 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005660 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005661 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5662 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005663 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5664 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005665 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005666 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005667 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5668 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005669 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005670 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5671 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005672 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005673 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005674 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005675 return;
5676 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005677
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005678 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5679 // deduction as a candidate.
5680 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005681 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005682 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005683}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005684
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005685/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005687/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005688/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005689/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5690/// conversion function produces).
5691void
5692Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005693 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005694 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005695 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5696 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005697 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5698 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005699 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005700 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5701 return;
5702
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005703 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005704 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005705
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005706 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005707 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005708 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005709 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005710 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005711 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005712 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005713 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005714 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005715 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005716 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005717
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005718 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005719 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5720 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005721 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005722 //
5723 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5724 // object parameter.
5725 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5726 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5727 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5728 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5729 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005730
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005731 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005732 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5733 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005734 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005735
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005736 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005737 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005738 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005739 return;
5740 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005741
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005742 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005743 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5744 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5745 QualType FromCanon
5746 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5747 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5748 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5749 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005750 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005751 return;
5752 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005753
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005754 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5755 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5756 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5757 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5758 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5759 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5760 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5761 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005762 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005763 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005764 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5765 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005766 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005767 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005768
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005769 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5770 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005771 Candidate.Viable = false;
5772 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5773 return;
5774 }
5775
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005776 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005777
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005778 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005779 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5780 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005781 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00005782 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, MultiExprArg(), CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005783 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005784 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005785 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005786 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005787 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5788 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005789
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005790 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005791 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5792 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005793
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005794 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5795 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005796 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005797 // shall have exact match rank.
5798 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5799 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5800 Candidate.Viable = false;
5801 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5802 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005803
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005804 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5805 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5806 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5807 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5808 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005809 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005810 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5811 Candidate.Viable = false;
5812 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5813 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005814 break;
5815
5816 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5817 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005818 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005819 break;
5820
5821 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005822 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005823 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5824 }
5825}
5826
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005827/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5828/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5829/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5830/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5831/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005832void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005833Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005834 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005835 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005836 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5837 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5838 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5839 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5840
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005841 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5842 return;
5843
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005844 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005845 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5846 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005847 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005848 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005849 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005850 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5851 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5852 Candidate.Viable = false;
5853 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5854 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5855 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005856 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005857 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005858 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005859 return;
5860 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005861
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005862 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5863 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5864 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005865 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005866 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005867}
5868
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005869/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5870/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5871/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5872/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5873/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5874void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005875 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005876 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005877 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005878 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005879 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005880 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005881 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5882 return;
5883
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005884 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005885 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005886
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005887 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005888 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005889 Candidate.Function = 0;
5890 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5891 Candidate.Viable = true;
5892 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005893 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005894 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005895
5896 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5897 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005898 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005899 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005900 Object->Classify(Context),
5901 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005902 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005903 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005904 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005905 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005906 return;
5907 }
5908
5909 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5910 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5911 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005912 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005913 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005914 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005915 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005916 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005917 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005918 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005919 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5920 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5921
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005922 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005923 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5924
5925 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5926 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5927 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005928 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005929 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005930 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005931 return;
5932 }
5933
5934 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5935 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005936 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005937 // Not enough arguments.
5938 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005939 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005940 return;
5941 }
5942
5943 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5944 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005945 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005946 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5947 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5948 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5949 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5950 // parameter of F.
5951 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005952 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005953 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005954 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005955 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5956 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005957 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005958 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005959 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005960 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005961 break;
5962 }
5963 } else {
5964 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5965 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5966 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005967 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005968 }
5969 }
5970}
5971
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005972/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5973/// member functions.
5974///
5975/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5976/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5977/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5978/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5979/// [over.match.oper]).
5980void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5981 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5982 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5983 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5984 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005985 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5986
5987 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5988 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5989 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5990 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5991 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5992 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5993 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5994 // constructed as follows:
5995 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005996
5997 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5998 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5999 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
6000 // empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006001 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006002 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00006003 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0))
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006004 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006005
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006006 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6007 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6008 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6009
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006010 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006011 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6012 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006013 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006014 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006015 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006016 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006017 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006018 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006019}
6020
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006021/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6022/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6023/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006024/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6025/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006026/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6027/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6028/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006029void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006030 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006031 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006032 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6033 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006034 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006035 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006036
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006037 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006038 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006039 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006040 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006041 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006042 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006043 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6044 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6045 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6046
6047 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6048 // arguments.
6049 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006050 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006051 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006052 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6053 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6054 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6055 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6056 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6057 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006058 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006059 //
6060 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6061 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6062 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6063 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006064 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006065 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006066 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006067 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6068 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006069 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006070 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006071 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006072 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006073 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6074 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006075 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006076 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006077 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006078 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006079 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006080 break;
6081 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006082 }
6083}
6084
6085/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6086/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6087/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6088/// enumeration types.
6089class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6090 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006091 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006092
6093 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6094 /// built-in candidates.
6095 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6096
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006097 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6098 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6099 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6100
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006101 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6102 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6103 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6104
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006105 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006106 /// candidates.
6107 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006108
6109 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6110 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6111
6112 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6113 /// were present in the candidate set.
6114 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6115
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006116 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6117 /// candidate set.
6118 bool HasNullPtrType;
6119
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006120 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6121 /// candidate type set.
6122 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006123
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006124 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6125 ASTContext &Context;
6126
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006127 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6128 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006129 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006130
6131public:
6132 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006133 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006134
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006135 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006136 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6137 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006138 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006139 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6140 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006141
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006142 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006143 SourceLocation Loc,
6144 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006145 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6146 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006147
6148 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6149 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6150
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006151 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006152 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6153
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006154 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6155 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6156
6157 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6158 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6159
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006160 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6161 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6162
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006163 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006164 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006165
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006166 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6167 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006168
6169 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6170 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006171 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006172};
6173
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006174/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006175/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6176/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6177/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6178/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6179/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6180/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006181///
6182/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006183bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006184BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6185 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006186
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006187 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006188 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006189 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006190
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006191 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006192 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006193 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006194 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006195 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6196 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6197 buildObjCPtr = true;
6198 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006199 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006200 }
6201
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006202 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6203 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6204 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6205 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6206 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6207 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006208
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006209 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006210 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6211 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006212
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006213 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6214 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6215 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006216 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006217 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006218
6219 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6220 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6221 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6222 (!hasRestrict ||
6223 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6224 continue;
6225
6226 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006227 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006228
6229 // Build qualified pointer type.
6230 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006231 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006232 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006233 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006234 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6235
6236 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6237 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006238 }
6239
6240 return true;
6241}
6242
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006243/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6244/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6245/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6246/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6247/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6248/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6249/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006250///
6251/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006252bool
6253BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6254 QualType Ty) {
6255 // Insert this type.
6256 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6257 return false;
6258
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006259 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6260 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006261
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006262 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006263 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6264 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6265 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6266 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6267 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6268 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006269 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6270
6271 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6272 // qualifiers.
6273 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6274 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6275 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006276
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006277 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006278 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6279 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006280 }
6281
6282 return true;
6283}
6284
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006285/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6286/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006287/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6288/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006289/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6290/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6291/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6292/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006293void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006294BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006295 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006296 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006297 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6298 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006299 // Only deal with canonical types.
6300 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6301
6302 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6303 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006304 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006305 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6306
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006307 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6308 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6309 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6310
6311 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006312 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006313
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006314 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6315 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6316 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6317
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006318 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6319 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6320 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6321
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006322 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6323 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6324 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006325 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6326 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006327 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006328 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006329 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6330 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6331 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6332 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006333 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006334 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006335 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006336 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006337 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6338 // extension.
6339 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006340 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006341 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6342 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006343 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6344 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6345 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6346 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006347
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006348 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006349 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6350 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6351 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6352 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6353 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006354 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6355 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6356 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006357
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006358 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6359 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6360 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6361 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006362
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006363 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6364 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6365 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6366 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006367 }
6368 }
6369 }
6370}
6371
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006372/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6373/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6374/// given type to the candidate set.
6375static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6376 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006377 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006378 unsigned NumArgs,
6379 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6380 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006381
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006382 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6383 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6384 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6385 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6386 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006387
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006388 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6389 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006390 ParamTypes[0]
6391 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006392 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6393 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006394 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006395 }
6396}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006397
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006398/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6399/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006400static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6401 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6402 const RecordType *TyRec;
6403 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6404 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006405 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006406 else
6407 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6408 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006409 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006410 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6411 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6412 return VRQuals;
6413 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006414
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006415 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006416 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6417 return VRQuals;
6418
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006419 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6420 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6421 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006422
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006423 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6424 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006425 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6426 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6427 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6428 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006429 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6430 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6431 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6432 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6433 // as see them.
6434 bool done = false;
6435 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006436 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6437 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006438 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6439 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006440 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006441 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6442 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6443 else
6444 done = true;
6445 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6446 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006447 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6448 return VRQuals;
6449 }
6450 }
6451 }
6452 return VRQuals;
6453}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006454
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006455namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006456
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006457/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6458/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6459/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6460/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6461class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006462 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6463 Sema &S;
6464 Expr **Args;
6465 unsigned NumArgs;
6466 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006467 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006468 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006469 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006470
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006471 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6472 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006473 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6474 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006475 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006476 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006477 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006478 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006479 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006480 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6481 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006482
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006483 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6484 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6485 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6486 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6487 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6488 // Start of promoted types.
6489 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6490 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6491 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006492
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006493 // Start of integral types.
6494 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6495 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6496 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006497 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006498 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6499 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6500 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006501 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006502 // End of promoted types.
6503
6504 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6505 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6506 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6507 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6508 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6509 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6510 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6511 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6512 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6513 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006514 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006515 };
6516 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6517 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006518
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006519 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6520 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6521 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6522 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6523 // The rules are basically:
6524 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6525 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6526 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6527 // - use the larger type
6528 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6529 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6530 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6531 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6532 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006533 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006534 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006535 Dep=-1,
6536 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006537 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006538 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006539 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006540/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6541/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6542/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6543/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6544/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6545/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6546/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6547/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6548/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6549/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6550/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006551 };
6552
6553 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6554 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6555 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6556
6557 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006558 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006559
6560 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6561 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006562 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6563 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006564 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6565 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6566
6567 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6568 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6569 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6570
6571 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6572 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6573 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6574 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6575 }
6576
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006577 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6578 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006579 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006580 bool HasVolatile,
6581 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006582 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6583 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6584 S.Context.IntTy
6585 };
6586
6587 // Non-volatile version.
6588 if (NumArgs == 1)
6589 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6590 else
6591 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6592
6593 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6594 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6595 if (HasVolatile) {
6596 ParamTypes[0] =
6597 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6598 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6599 if (NumArgs == 1)
6600 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6601 else
6602 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6603 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006604
6605 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6606 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6607 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6608 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6609 ParamTypes[0]
6610 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6611 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
6612 if (NumArgs == 1)
6613 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6614 else
6615 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6616
6617 if (HasVolatile) {
6618 ParamTypes[0]
6619 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6620 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6621 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6622 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
6623 if (NumArgs == 1)
6624 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1,
6625 CandidateSet);
6626 else
6627 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6628 }
6629 }
6630
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006631 }
6632
6633public:
6634 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6635 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6636 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006637 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006638 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006639 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6640 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6641 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006642 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6643 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006644 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6645 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6646 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006647 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006648 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006649 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006650 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006651 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006652 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6653 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006654 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006655 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006656 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006657 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6658 }
6659
6660 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6661 //
6662 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6663 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6664 // functions of the form
6665 //
6666 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6667 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6668 //
6669 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6670 //
6671 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6672 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6673 // candidate operator functions of the form
6674 //
6675 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6676 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6677 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006678 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6679 return;
6680
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006681 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6682 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6683 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006684 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006685 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6686 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006687 }
6688 }
6689
6690 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6691 //
6692 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6693 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6694 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6695 //
6696 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6697 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6698 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6699 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6700 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6701 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6702 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6703 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6704 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6705 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006706 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006707 continue;
6708
6709 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006710 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6711 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6712 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6713 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006714 }
6715 }
6716
6717 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6718 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6719 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6720 //
6721 // T& operator*(T*);
6722 //
6723 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006724 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006725 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006726 // T& operator*(T*);
6727 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6728 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6729 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6730 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6731 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6732 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6733 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006734 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6735 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006736
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006737 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6738 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6739 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006740
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006741 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6742 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6743 }
6744 }
6745
6746 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6747 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6748 // operator functions of the form
6749 //
6750 // T operator+(T);
6751 // T operator-(T);
6752 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006753 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6754 return;
6755
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006756 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6757 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006758 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006759 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6760 }
6761
6762 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6763 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6764 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6765 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6766 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6767 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6768 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6769 }
6770 }
6771
6772 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6773 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6774 // the form
6775 //
6776 // T* operator+(T*);
6777 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6778 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6779 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6780 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6781 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6782 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6783 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6784 }
6785 }
6786
6787 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6788 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6789 // operator functions of the form
6790 //
6791 // T operator~(T);
6792 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006793 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6794 return;
6795
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006796 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6797 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006798 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006799 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6800 }
6801
6802 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6803 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6804 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6805 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6806 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6807 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6808 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6809 }
6810 }
6811
6812 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6813 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6814 // functions of the form
6815 //
6816 // bool operator==(T,T);
6817 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6818 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6819 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6820 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6821
6822 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6823 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6824 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6825 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6826 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6827 ++MemPtr) {
6828 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6829 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6830 continue;
6831
6832 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6833 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6834 CandidateSet);
6835 }
6836 }
6837 }
6838
6839 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6840 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006841 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6842 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006843 //
6844 // bool operator<(T, T);
6845 // bool operator>(T, T);
6846 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6847 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6848 // bool operator==(T, T);
6849 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006850 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006851 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6852 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
6853 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
6854 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
6855 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006856 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006857 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
6858 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
6859 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
6860 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006861 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6862 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6863 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6864 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6865
6866 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6867 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6868 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6869 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6870 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6871 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6872 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6873 continue;
6874
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006875 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
6876 continue;
6877
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006878 QualType FirstParamType =
6879 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6880 QualType SecondParamType =
6881 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6882
6883 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6884 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6885 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6886 continue;
6887
6888 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6889 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6890 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6891 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6892 }
6893 }
6894 }
6895
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006896 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6897 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6898
6899 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6900 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6901 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6902 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6903 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6904 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6905 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6906 continue;
6907
6908 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6909 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6910 CandidateSet);
6911 }
6912 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6913 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6914 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6915 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6916 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6917
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006918 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6919 // candidate exists.
6920 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6921 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6922 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006923 continue;
6924
6925 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006926 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6927 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006928 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006929
6930 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6931 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6932 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6933 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6934 NullPtrTy))) {
6935 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6936 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6937 CandidateSet);
6938 }
6939 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006940 }
6941 }
6942
6943 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6944 //
6945 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6946 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6947 //
6948 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6949 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6950 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6951 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6952 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6953 //
6954 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6955 //
6956 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6957 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6958 //
6959 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6960 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6961 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6962 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6963
6964 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6965 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6966 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6967 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6968 };
6969 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6970 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6971 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6972 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006973 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6974 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6975 continue;
6976
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006977 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6978 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6979 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6980 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6981 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6982 CandidateSet);
6983 }
6984 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6985 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6986 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6987 continue;
6988
6989 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6990 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6991 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6992 }
6993 }
6994 }
6995 }
6996
6997 // C++ [over.built]p12:
6998 //
6999 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7000 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7001 //
7002 // LR operator*(L, R);
7003 // LR operator/(L, R);
7004 // LR operator+(L, R);
7005 // LR operator-(L, R);
7006 // bool operator<(L, R);
7007 // bool operator>(L, R);
7008 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7009 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7010 // bool operator==(L, R);
7011 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7012 //
7013 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7014 // between types L and R.
7015 //
7016 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7017 //
7018 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7019 // candidate operator functions of the form
7020 //
7021 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7022 //
7023 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7024 // between types L and R.
7025 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7026 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007027 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7028 return;
7029
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007030 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7031 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7032 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7033 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007034 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7035 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007036 QualType Result =
7037 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007038 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007039 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7040 }
7041 }
7042
7043 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7044 // conditional operator for vector types.
7045 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7046 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7047 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7048 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7049 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7050 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7051 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7052 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7053 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7054 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7055 if (!isComparison) {
7056 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7057 Result = *Vec1;
7058 else
7059 Result = *Vec2;
7060 }
7061
7062 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7063 }
7064 }
7065 }
7066
7067 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7068 //
7069 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7070 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7071 //
7072 // LR operator%(L, R);
7073 // LR operator&(L, R);
7074 // LR operator^(L, R);
7075 // LR operator|(L, R);
7076 // L operator<<(L, R);
7077 // L operator>>(L, R);
7078 //
7079 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7080 // between types L and R.
7081 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007082 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7083 return;
7084
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007085 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7086 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7087 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7088 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007089 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7090 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007091 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7092 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007093 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007094 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7095 }
7096 }
7097 }
7098
7099 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7100 //
7101 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7102 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7103 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7104 //
7105 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7106 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7107 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7108 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7109
7110 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7111 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7112 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7113 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7114 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7115 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7116 continue;
7117
7118 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
7119 CandidateSet);
7120 }
7121
7122 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7123 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7124 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7125 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7126 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7127 continue;
7128
7129 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
7130 CandidateSet);
7131 }
7132 }
7133 }
7134
7135 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7136 //
7137 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7138 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7139 // of the form
7140 //
7141 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7142 //
7143 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7144 //
7145 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7146 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7147 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7148 //
7149 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7150 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7151 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7152 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7153 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7154
7155 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7156 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7157 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7158 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7159 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7160 if (isEqualOp)
7161 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007162 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7163 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007164
7165 // non-volatile version
7166 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7167 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7168 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7169 };
7170 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7171 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7172
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007173 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7174 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7175 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007176 // volatile version
7177 ParamTypes[0] =
7178 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7179 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7180 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7181 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007182
7183 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7184 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7185 // restrict version
7186 ParamTypes[0]
7187 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7188 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7189 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7190
7191 if (NeedVolatile) {
7192 // volatile restrict version
7193 ParamTypes[0]
7194 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7195 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7196 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7197 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7198 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7199 CandidateSet,
7200 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7201 }
7202 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007203 }
7204
7205 if (isEqualOp) {
7206 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7207 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7208 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7209 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7210 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7211 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7212 continue;
7213
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007214 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7215 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7216 *Ptr,
7217 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007218
7219 // non-volatile version
7220 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7221 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7222
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007223 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7224 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7225 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007226 // volatile version
7227 ParamTypes[0] =
7228 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007229 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7230 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007231 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007232
7233 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7234 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7235 // restrict version
7236 ParamTypes[0]
7237 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7238 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7239 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7240
7241 if (NeedVolatile) {
7242 // volatile restrict version
7243 ParamTypes[0]
7244 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7245 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7246 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7247 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7249 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7250
7251 }
7252 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007253 }
7254 }
7255 }
7256
7257 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7258 //
7259 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7260 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7261 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7262 // the form
7263 //
7264 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7265 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7266 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7267 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7268 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7269 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007270 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7271 return;
7272
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007273 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7274 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7275 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7276 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007277 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007278
7279 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7280 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007281 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007282 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7283 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7284
7285 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7286 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7287 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007288 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007289 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007290 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7291 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007292 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7293 }
7294 }
7295 }
7296
7297 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7298 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7299 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7300 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7301 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7302 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7303 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7304 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7305 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7306 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7307 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7308 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7309 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7310 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7311 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7312
7313 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7314 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7315 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7316 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007317 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7318 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007319 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7320 }
7321 }
7322 }
7323 }
7324
7325 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7326 //
7327 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7328 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7329 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7330 //
7331 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7332 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7333 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7334 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7335 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7336 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7337 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007338 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7339 return;
7340
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007341 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7342 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7343 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7344 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007345 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007346
7347 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7348 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007349 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007350 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7351 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7352 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007353 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007354 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7355 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7356 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7357 CandidateSet);
7358 }
7359 }
7360 }
7361 }
7362
7363 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7364 //
7365 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7366 //
7367 // bool operator!(bool);
7368 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7369 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7370 void addExclaimOverload() {
7371 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7372 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7373 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7374 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7375 }
7376 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7377 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7378 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7379 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7380 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7381 }
7382
7383 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7384 //
7385 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7386 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7387 //
7388 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7389 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7390 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7391 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7392 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7393 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7394 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7395 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7396 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7397 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7398 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7399 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007400 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7401 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007402
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007403 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7404
7405 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7406 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7407 }
7408
7409 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7410 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7411 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7412 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7413 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7414 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007415 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7416 continue;
7417
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007418 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7419
7420 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7421 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7422 }
7423 }
7424
7425 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7426 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7427 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7428 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7429 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7430 //
7431 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7432 //
7433 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7434 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7435 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7436 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7437 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7438 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7439 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7440 QualType C1;
7441 QualifierCollector Q1;
7442 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7443 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7444 continue;
7445 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7446 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7447 // volatile/restrict type.
7448 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7449 continue;
7450 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7451 continue;
7452 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7453 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7454 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7455 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7456 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7457 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7458 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7459 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7460 break;
7461 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7462 // build CV12 T&
7463 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7464 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7465 T.isVolatileQualified())
7466 continue;
7467 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7468 T.isRestrictQualified())
7469 continue;
7470 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7471 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7472 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7473 }
7474 }
7475 }
7476
7477 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7478 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7479 // therefore added as binary.
7480 //
7481 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7482 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7483 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7484 //
7485 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7486 //
7487 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7488 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7489 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7490
7491 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7492 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7493 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7494 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7495 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7496 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7497 continue;
7498
7499 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7500 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7501 }
7502
7503 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7504 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7505 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7506 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7507 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7508 continue;
7509
7510 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7511 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7512 }
7513
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007514 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007515 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7516 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7517 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7518 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7519 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7520 continue;
7521
7522 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7523 continue;
7524
7525 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7526 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7527 }
7528 }
7529 }
7530 }
7531};
7532
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007533} // end anonymous namespace
7534
7535/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7536/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7537/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7538/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7539/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7540void
7541Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7542 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7543 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7544 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007545 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7546 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007547 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7548 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007549 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7550 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007551 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7552 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007553
7554 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7555 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007556 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007557 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7558 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7559 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7560 OpLoc,
7561 true,
7562 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7563 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7564 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7565 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007566 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7567 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7568 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7569 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7570 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007571 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007572
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007573 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7574 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007575 //
7576 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7577 // 'bool' overloads.
7578 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7579 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007580 return;
7581
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007582 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7583 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7584 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007585 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007586 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7587
7588 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007589 switch (Op) {
7590 case OO_None:
7591 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007592 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007593
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007594 case OO_New:
7595 case OO_Delete:
7596 case OO_Array_New:
7597 case OO_Array_Delete:
7598 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007599 llvm_unreachable(
7600 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007601
7602 case OO_Comma:
7603 case OO_Arrow:
7604 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7605 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7606 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007607 break;
7608
7609 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007610 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007611 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007612 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007613
7614 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007615 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007616 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007617 } else {
7618 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7619 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7620 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007621 break;
7622
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007623 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007624 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007625 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7626 else
7627 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7628 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007629
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007630 case OO_Slash:
7631 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007632 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007633
7634 case OO_PlusPlus:
7635 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007636 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7637 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007638 break;
7639
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007640 case OO_EqualEqual:
7641 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007642 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007643 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007644
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007645 case OO_Less:
7646 case OO_Greater:
7647 case OO_LessEqual:
7648 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007649 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007650 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7651 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007652
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007653 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007654 case OO_Caret:
7655 case OO_Pipe:
7656 case OO_LessLess:
7657 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007658 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007659 break;
7660
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007661 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7662 if (NumArgs == 1)
7663 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7664 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7665 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7666 break;
7667
7668 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7669 break;
7670
7671 case OO_Tilde:
7672 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7673 break;
7674
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007675 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007676 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007677 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007678
7679 case OO_PlusEqual:
7680 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007681 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007682 // Fall through.
7683
7684 case OO_StarEqual:
7685 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007686 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007687 break;
7688
7689 case OO_PercentEqual:
7690 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7691 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7692 case OO_AmpEqual:
7693 case OO_CaretEqual:
7694 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007695 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007696 break;
7697
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007698 case OO_Exclaim:
7699 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007700 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007701
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007702 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007703 case OO_PipePipe:
7704 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007705 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007706
7707 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007708 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007709 break;
7710
7711 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007712 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007713 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007714
7715 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007716 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007717 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7718 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007719 }
7720}
7721
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007722/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7723/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7724///
7725/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7726/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7727/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7728/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007729void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007730Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007731 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007732 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007733 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007734 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007735 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007736 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007737
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007738 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7739 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7740 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7741 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7742 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7743 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7744
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007745 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007746 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007747
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007748 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007749 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7750 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7751 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007752 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007753 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007754 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007755 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007756 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007757
7758 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7759 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007760 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007761 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007762 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007763 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007764 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007765
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007766 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7767 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007768 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007769 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007770 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007771 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007772 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007773}
7774
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007775/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7776/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007777bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007778isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007779 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7780 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007781 SourceLocation Loc,
7782 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007783 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7784 // functions.
7785 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7786 return Cand1.Viable;
7787 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7788 return false;
7789
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007790 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7791 //
7792 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7793 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7794 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7795 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7796 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7797 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7798 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007799
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007800 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007801 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7802 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007803 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007804 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7805 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007806 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007807 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007808 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7809 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007810 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7811 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7812 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7813 HasBetterConversion = true;
7814 break;
7815
7816 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7817 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7818 return false;
7819
7820 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7821 // Do nothing.
7822 break;
7823 }
7824 }
7825
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007826 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007827 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007828 if (HasBetterConversion)
7829 return true;
7830
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007831 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007832 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007833 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007834 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7835 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007836
7837 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7838 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7839 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007840 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007841 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007842 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007843 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007844 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7845 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7846 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007847 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007848 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007849 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007850 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007851 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007852
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007853 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7854 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7855 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7856 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7857 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7858 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007859 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007860 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007861 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007862 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7863 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7864 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7865 // pointer or block.
7866 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7867 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7868 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7869 return FuncResult;
7870
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007871 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7872 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007873 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7874 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7875 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7876 return true;
7877
7878 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7879 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7880 return false;
7881
7882 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7883 // Do nothing
7884 break;
7885 }
7886 }
7887
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007888 return false;
7889}
7890
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007891/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007892/// within an overload candidate set.
7893///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007894/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007895/// which overload resolution occurs.
7896///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007897/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
7898/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007899///
7900/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007901OverloadingResult
7902OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007903 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007904 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007905 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007906 Best = end();
7907 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7908 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007909 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007910 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007911 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007912 }
7913
7914 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007915 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007916 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7917
7918 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7919 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007920 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007921 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007922 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007923 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007924 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007925 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007926 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007927 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007928 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007929
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007930 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007931 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007932 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7933 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007934 return OR_Deleted;
7935
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007936 return OR_Success;
7937}
7938
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007939namespace {
7940
7941enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7942 oc_function,
7943 oc_method,
7944 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007945 oc_function_template,
7946 oc_method_template,
7947 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007948 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7949 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007950 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007951 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007952 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007953 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007954};
7955
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007956OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7957 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7958 std::string &Description) {
7959 bool isTemplate = false;
7960
7961 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7962 isTemplate = true;
7963 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7964 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7965 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007966
7967 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007968 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007969 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007970
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007971 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7972 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7973
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007974 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7975 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7976
7977 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7978 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7979
7980 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7981 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7982 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007983 }
7984
7985 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7986 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7987 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007988 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007989 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007990
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007991 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7992 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7993
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00007994 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
7995 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7996
7997 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
7998 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007999 }
8000
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008001 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008002}
8003
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008004void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
8005 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8006 if (!Ctor) return;
8007
8008 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8009 if (!Ctor) return;
8010
8011 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8012}
8013
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008014} // end anonymous namespace
8015
8016// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008017void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008018 std::string FnDesc;
8019 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008020 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8021 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8022 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8023 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008024 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008025}
8026
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008027//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8028// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008029void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008030 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8031
8032 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8033 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8034
8035 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8036 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8037 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8038 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8039 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008040 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008041 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8042 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008043 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008044 }
8045 }
8046}
8047
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008048/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8049/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8050/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008051void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8052 Sema &S,
8053 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8054 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8055 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8056 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008057 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8058 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8059 // refactoring here.
8060 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8061 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8062 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8063 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8064 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8065 break;
8066 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008067 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008068 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008069 if (I != E)
8070 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008071}
8072
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008073namespace {
8074
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008075void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8076 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8077 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008078 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8079 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8080
8081 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8082 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8083 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008084 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008085 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008086 if (I == 0)
8087 isObjectArgument = true;
8088 else
8089 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008090 }
8091
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008092 std::string FnDesc;
8093 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8094
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008095 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8096 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8097 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008098
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008099 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008100 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008101 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8102 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8103 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008104 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008105
8106 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8107 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8108 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8109 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008110 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008111 return;
8112 }
8113
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008114 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8115 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008116 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8117 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8118 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8119 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8120 else {
8121 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8122 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8123 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8124 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8125 }
8126
8127 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8128 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008129 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8130 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8131
8132 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8133 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8134 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8135 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8136 << FromTy
8137 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8138 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008139 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008140 return;
8141 }
8142
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008143 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008144 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008145 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8146 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8147 << FromTy
8148 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8149 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8150 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8151 return;
8152 }
8153
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008154 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8155 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8156 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8157 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8158 << FromTy
8159 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8160 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8161 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8162 return;
8163 }
8164
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008165 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8166 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8167
8168 if (isObjectArgument) {
8169 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8170 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8171 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8172 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8173 } else {
8174 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8175 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8176 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8177 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8178 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008179 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008180 return;
8181 }
8182
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008183 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8184 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8185 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8186 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8187 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8188 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8189 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8190 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8191 return;
8192 }
8193
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008194 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8195 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8196 // the failure.
8197 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8198 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8199 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8200 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8201 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8202 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8203 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8204 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008205 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008206 return;
8207 }
8208
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008209 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008210 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008211 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8212 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8213 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8214 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8215 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8216 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008217 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008218 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008219 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008220 }
8221 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8222 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8223 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8224 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8225 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8226 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8227 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8228 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8229 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008230 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8231 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008232 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8233 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8234 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8235 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8236 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8237 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8238 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8239 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008240 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8241 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8242 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8243 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8244 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8245 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008246 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008247 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008248
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008249 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008250 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008251 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008252 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8253 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008254 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008255 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008256 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008257 return;
8258 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008259
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008260 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8261 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8262 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8263 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8264 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8265 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8266 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8267 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8268 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8269 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8270 return;
8271 }
8272 }
8273
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008274 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8275 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8276 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008277 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008278 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8279 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8280
8281 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008282 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8283 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008284 FDiag << *HI;
8285 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8286
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008287 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008288}
8289
8290void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8291 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8292 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8293
8294 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8295 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8296
8297 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008298
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008299 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8300 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8301 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8302 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8303 // Just don't report anything.
8304 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8305 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8306 return;
8307
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008308 // at least / at most / exactly
8309 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8310 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008311 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8312 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8313 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008314 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008315 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008316 mode = 0; // "at least"
8317 else
8318 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8319 modeCount = MinParams;
8320 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008321 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8322 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8323 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008324 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8325 mode = 1; // "at most"
8326 else
8327 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8328 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8329 }
8330
8331 std::string Description;
8332 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8333
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008334 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8335 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8336 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8337 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8338 else
8339 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8340 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8341 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008342 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008343}
8344
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008345/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8346void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008347 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008348 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8349
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008350 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008351 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8352 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8353 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8354 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008355 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8356 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8357 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8358
8359 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008360 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8361 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8362 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008363 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008364 return;
8365 }
8366
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008367 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8368 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8369 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8370
8371 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8372
8373 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8374 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008375 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008376 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008377 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008378 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8379
8380 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8381 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8382 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8383 // done on dependent types).
8384 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8385
8386 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8387 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008388 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008389 return;
8390 }
8391
8392 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008393 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008394 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008395 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008396 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008397 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008398 which = 1;
8399 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008400 which = 2;
8401 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008402
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008403 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008404 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008405 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8406 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008407 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008408 return;
8409 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008410
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008411 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008412 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008413 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008414 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008415 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8416 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8417 else {
8418 int index = 0;
8419 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8420 index = TTP->getIndex();
8421 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8422 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8423 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8424 else
8425 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008426 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008427 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8428 << (index + 1);
8429 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008430 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008431 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008432
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008433 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8434 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8435 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8436 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008437
8438 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8439 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008440 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008441 return;
8442
8443 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008444 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008445 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008446 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8447 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8448 TemplateArgString = " ";
8449 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8450 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8451 }
8452
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008453 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8454 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8455 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8456 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8457 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8458 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8459 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8460 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8461 return;
8462 }
8463
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008464 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8465 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8466 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008467 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008468 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008469 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008470 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8471 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8472 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8473 }
8474
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008475 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008476 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008477 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008478 return;
8479 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008480
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8482 OverloadExpr::FindResult R =
8483 OverloadExpr::find(Cand->DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8484 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8485 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8486 << R.Expression->getName();
8487 return;
8488 }
8489
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008490 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8491 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
8492 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
8493 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8494 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8495 return;
8496
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008497 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8498 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008499 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008500 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008501 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008502 return;
8503 }
8504}
8505
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008506/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8507void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8508 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8509 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8510
8511 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8512 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8513
8514 std::string FnDesc;
8515 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8516
8517 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8518 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8519}
8520
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008521/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8522/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8523///
8524/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8525/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8526/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8527/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8528/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8529/// overload.
8530///
8531/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8532/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8533/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008534void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008535 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008536 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8537
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008538 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008539 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8540 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008541 std::string FnDesc;
8542 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008543
8544 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008545 << FnKind << FnDesc
8546 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008547 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008548 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008549 }
8550
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008551 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8552 if (Cand->Viable) {
8553 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8554 return;
8555 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008556
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008557 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8558 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8559 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8560 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008561
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008562 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008563 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008564
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008565 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8566 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008567 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008568 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008569
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008570 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8571 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008572 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008573 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8574 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008575
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008576 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8577 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8578 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8579 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008580 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008581
8582 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8583 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008584 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008585}
8586
8587void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8588 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8589 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8590 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8591 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8592 bool isLValueReference = false;
8593 bool isRValueReference = false;
8594 bool isPointer = false;
8595 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8596 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8597 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8598 isLValueReference = true;
8599 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8600 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8601 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8602 isRValueReference = true;
8603 }
8604 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8605 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8606 isPointer = true;
8607 }
8608 // Desugar down to a function type.
8609 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8610 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8611 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8612 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8613 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8614
8615 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8616 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008617 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008618}
8619
8620void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008621 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008622 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8623 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008624 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008625 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8626 TypeStr += Opc;
8627 TypeStr += "(";
8628 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008629 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008630 TypeStr += ")";
8631 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8632 } else {
8633 TypeStr += ", ";
8634 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8635 TypeStr += ")";
8636 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8637 }
8638}
8639
8640void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8641 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008642 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008643 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8644 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008645 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8646 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8647
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008648 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008649 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008650 }
8651}
8652
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008653SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8654 if (Cand->Function)
8655 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008656 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008657 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8658 return SourceLocation();
8659}
8660
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008661static unsigned
8662RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008663 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008664 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008665 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008666
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008667 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008668 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8669 return 1;
8670
8671 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8672 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8673 return 2;
8674
8675 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8676 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008677 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008678 return 3;
8679
8680 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8681 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8682 return 4;
8683
8684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8685 return 5;
8686
8687 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8688 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8689 return 6;
8690 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008691 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008692}
8693
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008694struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8695 Sema &S;
8696 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008697
8698 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8699 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008700 // Fast-path this check.
8701 if (L == R) return false;
8702
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008703 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008704 if (L->Viable) {
8705 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8706
8707 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8708 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8709 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008710 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8711 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008712 } else if (R->Viable)
8713 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008714
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008715 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008716
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008717 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8718 if (!L->Viable) {
8719 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8720 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8721 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8722 return false;
8723 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8724 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8725 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008726
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008727 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8728 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8729 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8730 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8731 return true;
8732
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008733 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8734 // comes first.
8735 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8736 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8737 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8738 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008739 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008740 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8741 return true;
8742 else
8743 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008744 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008745
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008746 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8747 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008748 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008749
8750 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008751 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008752 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008753 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8754 L->Conversions[I],
8755 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008756 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8757 leftBetter++;
8758 break;
8759
8760 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8761 leftBetter--;
8762 break;
8763
8764 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8765 break;
8766 }
8767 }
8768 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8769 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8770
8771 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8772 return false;
8773
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008774 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8775 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8776 return true;
8777
8778 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8779 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008780 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008781 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8782 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008783
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008784 // TODO: others?
8785 }
8786
8787 // Sort everything else by location.
8788 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8789 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8790
8791 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8792 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8793 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8794
8795 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008796 }
8797};
8798
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008799/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008800/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008801void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008802 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008803 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8804
8805 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8806 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8807
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008808 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8809 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008810 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8811 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008812
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008813 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008814 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008815 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008816 while (true) {
8817 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8818 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008819 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008820 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008821 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008822 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008823 }
8824
8825 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8826 return;
8827
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008828 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8829 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8830
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008831 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008832 // operation somehow.
8833 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008834
8835 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8836 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8837
8838 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8839 QualType ConvType
8840 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8841 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8842 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8843 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8844 ArgIdx--;
8845 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8846 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8847 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8848 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8849 ArgIdx--;
8850 } else {
8851 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8852 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8853 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8854 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008855 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8856 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008857 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008858 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8859 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008860 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008861 return;
8862 }
8863
8864 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8865 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8866 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008867 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008868 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008869 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008870 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008871 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8872 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008873 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008874 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8875 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008876 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008877 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008878 else
8879 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8880 }
8881}
8882
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008883} // end anonymous namespace
8884
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008885/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8886/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008887/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008888void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8889 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008890 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008891 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008892 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008893 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8894 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008895 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008896 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8897 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008898 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008899 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008900 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008901 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008902 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8903 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8904 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8905 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008906 }
8907 }
8908
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008909 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008910 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008911
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008912 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008913
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008914 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008915 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008916 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008917 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8918 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008919
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008920 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8921 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8922 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008923 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008924 break;
8925 }
8926 ++CandsShown;
8927
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008928 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008929 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008930 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008931 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008932 else {
8933 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8934 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008935 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8936 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8937 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8938 //
8939 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8940 // different ambiguities, though.
8941 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008942 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008943 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8944 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008945
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008946 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008947 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008948 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008949 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008950
8951 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008952 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008953}
8954
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008955// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8956// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8957// R (A) --> R(A)
8958// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8959// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8960// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8961QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8962 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8963 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8964 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8965 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8966 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8967 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8968 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008969 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008970 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8971 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8972 Ret =
8973 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8974 return Ret;
8975}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008976
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008977// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8978// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8979class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8980{
8981 Sema& S;
8982 Expr* SourceExpr;
8983 const QualType& TargetType;
8984 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8985
8986 bool Complain;
8987 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8988 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008989
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008990 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8991 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008992
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008993 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8994 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8995 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008996 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008997
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008998public:
8999 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
9000 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
9001 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9002 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9003 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9004 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9005 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9006 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9007 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
9008 {
9009 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9010
9011 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9012 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9013 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009014 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009015 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009016
9017 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9018 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9019 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
9020 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
9021 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9022 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9023
9024 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9025 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9026 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9027 return;
9028 }
9029 }
9030
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009031 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
9032 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009033 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009034 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009035 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009036
9037 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9038 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009039
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009040 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9041 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9042 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9043 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9044 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9045 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9046 else
9047 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9048 }
9049 }
9050 }
9051
9052private:
9053 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9054 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9055 }
9056
9057 // [ToType] [Return]
9058
9059 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9060 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9061 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9062 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9063 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9064 }
9065
9066 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9067 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9068 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9069 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9070 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9071 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9072 // static when converting to member pointer.
9073 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9074 return false;
9075 }
9076 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9077 return false;
9078
9079 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9080 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9081 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9082 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9083 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9084 // overloaded functions considered.
9085 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009086 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009087 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9088 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9089 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9090 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
9091 Info)) {
9092 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9093 (void)Result;
9094 return false;
9095 }
9096
9097 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
9098 // This function template specicalization works.
9099 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
9100 assert(TargetFunctionType
9101 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
9102 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9103 return true;
9104 }
9105
9106 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9107 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009108 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009109 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9110 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009111 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9112 return false;
9113 }
9114 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9115 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009116
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009117 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009118 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009119 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9120 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9121 return false;
9122
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009123 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009124 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9125 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009126 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9127 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009128 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9129 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009130 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009131 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009132 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009133 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009134
9135 return false;
9136 }
9137
9138 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9139 bool Ret = false;
9140
9141 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9142 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9143 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9144 return false;
9145
9146 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9147 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9148 I != E; ++I) {
9149 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9150 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9151
9152 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9153 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9154 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9155 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9156 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9157 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9158 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9159 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9160 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9161 Ret = true;
9162 }
9163 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9164 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9165 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9166 Ret = true;
9167 }
9168 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9169 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009170 }
9171
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009172 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009173 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9174 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9175 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9176 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9177 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9178
9179 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9180 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9181 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9182 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009183
9184 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9185 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9186 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009187
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009188 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009189 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9190 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9191 S.PDiag(),
9192 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9193 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9194 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9195 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009196 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009197
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009198 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9199 // Make it the first and only element
9200 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9201 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9202 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009203 }
9204 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009205
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009206 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9207 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9208 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9209 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9210 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9211 ++I;
9212 else {
9213 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9214 Matches.set_size(N);
9215 }
9216 }
9217 }
9218
9219public:
9220 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9221 assert(Matches.empty());
9222 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9223 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9224 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009225 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009226 }
9227
9228 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9229 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9230 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9231 }
9232
9233 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9234 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9235 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9236 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9237 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9238 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9239 }
9240
9241 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9242 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9243 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9244 }
9245
9246 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9247 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9248 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9249 << OvlExpr->getName()
9250 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009251 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009252 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009253
9254 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9255
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009256 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9257
9258 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9259 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9260 return Matches[0].second;
9261 }
9262
9263 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9264 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9265 return &Matches[0].first;
9266 }
9267};
9268
9269/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9270/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9271/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9272/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9273///
9274/// @code
9275/// int f(double);
9276/// int f(int);
9277///
9278/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9279/// @endcode
9280///
9281/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9282/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9283/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9284FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009285Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9286 QualType TargetType,
9287 bool Complain,
9288 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9289 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009290 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009291
9292 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9293 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009294 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9295 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009296 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009297 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9298 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9299 else
9300 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9301 }
9302 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9303 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9304 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9305 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9306 assert(Fn);
9307 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009308 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009309 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009310 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009311
9312 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9313 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009314 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009315}
9316
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009317/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009318/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9319///
9320/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9321/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009322/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009323/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009324FunctionDecl *
9325Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9326 bool Complain,
9327 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009328 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9329 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9330 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009331 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9332 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9333 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009334
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009335 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009336 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009337 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009338
9339 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009340 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009341
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009342 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9343 // whose type matches exactly.
9344 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009345 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9346 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009347 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9348 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009349 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9350 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9351 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009352 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009353 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9354 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009355
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009356 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9357 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9358 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9359 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9360 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9361 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009362 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009363 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009364 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9365 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9366 Specialization, Info)) {
9367 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9368 (void)Result;
9369 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009370 }
9371
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009372 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9373
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009374 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009375 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009376 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009377 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9378 << ovl->getName();
9379 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009380 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009381 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009382 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009383
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009384 Matched = Specialization;
9385 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009386 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009387
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009388 return Matched;
9389}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009390
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009391
9392
9393
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009394// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9395// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9396//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009397// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009398//
9399// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9400// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9401// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9402bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9403 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9404 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009405 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009406 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009407 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009408
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009409 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009410
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009411 DeclAccessPair found;
9412 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9413 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9414 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009415 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009416 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9417 return true;
9418 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009419
9420 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9421 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9422 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9423 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9424 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9425 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9426 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009427 if (!complain) return false;
9428
9429 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9430 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9431 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9432
9433 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9434 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9435 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9436 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9437 // the static candidates were rejected.
9438 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9439 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009440 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009441
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009442 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009443 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009444 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009445
9446 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009447 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009448 SingleFunctionExpression =
9449 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009450 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9451 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9452 return true;
9453 }
9454 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009455 }
9456
9457 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9458 if (complain) {
9459 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9460 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9461 << DestTypeForComplaining
9462 << OpRangeForComplaining
9463 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009464 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9465
9466 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9467 return true;
9468 }
9469
9470 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009471 }
9472
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009473 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9474 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009475}
9476
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009477/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9478static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009479 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009480 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009481 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009482 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009483 bool PartialOverloading,
9484 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009485 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009486 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9487 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9488
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009489 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009490 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9491 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9492 return;
9493 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009494 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9495 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009496 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009497 }
9498
9499 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9500 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009501 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009502 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009503 return;
9504 }
9505
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009506 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009507}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009508
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009509/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9510/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009511void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009512 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009513 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9514 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009515
9516#ifndef NDEBUG
9517 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9518 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009519 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009520 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9521 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9522 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9523 //
9524 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9525 //
9526 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009527 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009528 //
9529 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9530 // template
9531 //
9532 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009533
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009534 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9535 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9536 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9537 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9538 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9539 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9540 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009541 }
9542 }
9543#endif
9544
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009545 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9546 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009547 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009548 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9549 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9550 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9551 }
9552
9553 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9554 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009555 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9556 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9557 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009558
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009559 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009560 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009561 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009562 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009563 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009564}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009565
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009566/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9567/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9568/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9569/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9570///
9571/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9572static bool
9573DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9574 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9575 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009576 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009577 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9578 return false;
9579
9580 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009581 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9582 continue;
9583
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009584 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9585
9586 if (!R.empty()) {
9587 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9588
9589 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9590 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9591 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9592 R.clear();
9593 return false;
9594 }
9595
9596 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9597 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9598 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009599 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009600 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009601
9602 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009603 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009604 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9605 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009606 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009607 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009608 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009609
9610 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9611 // declaring the function there instead.
9612 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9613 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009614 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009615 AssociatedNamespaces,
9616 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009617 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009618 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9619 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9620 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9621 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +00009622 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
9623 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
9624 continue;
9625
9626 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a reserved
9627 // name, like __gnu_cxx.
9628 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9629 if (NS &&
9630 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
9631 continue;
9632
9633 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009634 }
9635
9636 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9637 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009638 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009639 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9640 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9641 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009642 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009643 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9644 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009645 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009646 } else {
9647 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9648 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9649 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9650 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9651 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9652 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9653 }
9654
9655 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9656 return true;
9657 }
9658
9659 R.clear();
9660 }
9661
9662 return false;
9663}
9664
9665/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9666/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9667/// was defined.
9668///
9669/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9670static bool
9671DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9672 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009673 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009674 DeclarationName OpName =
9675 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9676 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9677 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009678 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009679}
9680
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009681namespace {
9682// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9683// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9684// that accept the given number of arguments.
9685class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9686 public:
9687 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9688 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009689 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009690 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9691 }
9692
9693 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9694 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9695 return candidate.isKeyword();
9696
9697 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9698 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9699 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9700 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9701 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9702 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9703 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9704 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9705 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9706 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9707 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9708 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9709 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9710 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9711 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9712 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9713 return true;
9714 }
9715 }
9716 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9717 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9718 return true;
9719 }
9720 return false;
9721 }
9722
9723 private:
9724 unsigned NumArgs;
9725 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9726};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009727
9728// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9729class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9730 public:
9731 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9732 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9733 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9734 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9735 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9736 }
9737
9738 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9739 return false;
9740 }
9741};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009742
9743class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9744 Sema &SemaRef;
9745public:
9746 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9747 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9748 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9749 }
9750
9751 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9752 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9753 }
9754};
9755
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009756}
9757
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009758/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9759///
9760/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009761static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009762BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009763 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9764 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009765 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009766 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009767 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009768 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9769 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9770 //
9771 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9772 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9773 //
9774 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9775 return ExprError();
9776 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009777
9778 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009779 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009780 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009781
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009782 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009783 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009784 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9785 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9786 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9787 }
9788
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009789 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9790 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009791 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009792 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9793 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9794 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9795 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009796 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009797 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009798 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009799 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009800 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009801 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009802
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009803 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9804
9805 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9806 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009807 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009808 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009809 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9810 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009811 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009812 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009813 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009814 else
9815 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9816
9817 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009818 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009819
9820 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009821 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009822 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009823 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009824 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9825 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009826}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009827
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009828/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
9829/// the given function.
9830/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
9831bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9832 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9833 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9834 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9835 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9836 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009837#ifndef NDEBUG
9838 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9839 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9840 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9841
9842 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9843 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9844 FunctionDecl *F;
9845 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9846 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9847 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009848 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009849
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009850 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009851 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009852 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009853#endif
9854
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009855 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009856 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) {
9857 *Result = ExprError();
9858 return true;
9859 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009860
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009861 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9862 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009863 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009864 *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009865
9866 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009867 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9868 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009869 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009870 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9871 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009872 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009873 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009874 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009875 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009876 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
9877 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9878 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9879 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009880 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009881 *Result = Owned(CE);
9882 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009883 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009884 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009885 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009886
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009887 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009888 return false;
9889}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009890
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009891/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
9892/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
9893/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
9894static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9895 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9896 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9897 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9898 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9899 Expr *ExecConfig,
9900 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9901 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
9902 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
9903 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9904 if (CandidateSet->empty())
9905 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9906 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9907 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9908 AllowTypoCorrection);
9909
9910 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009911 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009912 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9913 SemaRef.MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
9914 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
9915 SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
9916 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9917 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9918 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009919 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009920
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009921 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9922 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9923 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009924 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009925 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9926 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009927 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9928 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009929 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9930 return Recovery;
9931
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009932 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009933 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009934 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009935 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9936 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009937 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009938 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009939
9940 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009941 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009942 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009943 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9944 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009945 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009946
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009947 case OR_Deleted: {
9948 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9949 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
9950 << ULE->getName()
9951 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
9952 << Fn->getSourceRange();
9953 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9954 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009955
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009956 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9957 // the call in the AST.
9958 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9959 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9960 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9961 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
9962 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009963 }
9964
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009965 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009966 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009967}
9968
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009969/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
9970/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9971/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9972/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9973/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
9974/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
9975ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9976 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9977 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9978 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9979 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9980 Expr *ExecConfig,
9981 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9982 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
9983 ExprResult result;
9984
9985 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, NumArgs, LParenLoc,
9986 &CandidateSet, &result))
9987 return result;
9988
9989 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9990 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
9991 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
9992
9993 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9994 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
9995 &Best, OverloadResult,
9996 AllowTypoCorrection);
9997}
9998
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009999static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010000 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10001 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10002}
10003
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010004/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10005/// operator.
10006///
10007/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10008///
10009/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10010/// operator.
10011///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010012/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010013/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10014/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10015/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10016/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10017/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10018///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010019/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010020ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010021Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10022 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010023 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010024 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010025
10026 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10027 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10028 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010029 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10030 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010031
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010032 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10033 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010034
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010035 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10036 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010037
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010038 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10039 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10040 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010041 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010042 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010043 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10044 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010045 NumArgs = 2;
10046 }
10047
10048 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010049 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010050 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010051 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010052 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010053 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010054 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010055
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010056 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010057 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010058 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010059 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010060 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10061 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010062 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010063 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010064 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010065 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010066 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010067 }
10068
10069 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010070 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010071
10072 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010073 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
10074 false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010075
10076 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10077 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10078
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010079 // Add candidates from ADL.
10080 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010081 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010082 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10083 CandidateSet);
10084
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010085 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010086 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010087
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010088 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10089
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010090 // Perform overload resolution.
10091 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010092 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010093 case OR_Success: {
10094 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10095 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010096
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010097 if (FnDecl) {
10098 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10099 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010100
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010101 // Convert the arguments.
10102 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010103 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010104
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010105 ExprResult InputRes =
10106 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10107 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10108 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010109 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010110 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010111 } else {
10112 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010113 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010114 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010115 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010116 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010117 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010118 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010119 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010120 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010121 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010122 }
10123
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010124 // Determine the result type.
10125 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10126 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10127 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010128
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010129 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010130 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010131 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010132 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10133 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010134
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010135 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010136 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010137 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010138 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010139 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010140
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010141 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010142 FnDecl))
10143 return ExprError();
10144
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010145 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010146 } else {
10147 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10148 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10149 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010150 ExprResult InputRes =
10151 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10152 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10153 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10154 return ExprError();
10155 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010156 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010157 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010158 }
10159
10160 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010161 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10162 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10163 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010164 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
10165 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010166 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10167 return ExprError();
10168
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010169 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10170 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10171 break;
10172
10173 case OR_Ambiguous:
10174 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10175 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10176 << Input->getType()
10177 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010178 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10179 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010180 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10181 return ExprError();
10182
10183 case OR_Deleted:
10184 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10185 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10186 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10187 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10188 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010189 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10190 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010191 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010192 return ExprError();
10193 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010194
10195 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10196 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10197 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010198 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010199}
10200
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010201/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10202/// operator.
10203///
10204/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10205///
10206/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10207/// operator.
10208///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010209/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010210/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10211/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10212/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10213/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10214/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10215///
10216/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10217/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010218ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010219Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010220 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010221 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010222 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010223 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010224 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010225
10226 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10227 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10228 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10229
10230 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10231 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010232 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010233 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010234 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010235 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010236 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010237 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010238 Context.DependentTy,
10239 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010240 OpLoc,
10241 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010242
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010243 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10244 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010245 VK_LValue,
10246 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010247 Context.DependentTy,
10248 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010249 OpLoc,
10250 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010251 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010252
10253 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010254 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010255 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10256 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010257 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010258 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10259 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10260 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010261 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010262 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10263 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10264 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010265 }
10266
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010267 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10268 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10269 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010270
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010271 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10272 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10273 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010274 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10275 return ExprError();
10276
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010277 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10278 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10279 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10280 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10281 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10282 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010283 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010284 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010285
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010286 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10287 // create a built-in binary operator.
10288 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10289 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10290
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010291 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010292 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010293
10294 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010295 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010296
10297 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10298 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10299
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010300 // Add candidates from ADL.
10301 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010302 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010303 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10304 CandidateSet);
10305
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010306 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010307 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010308
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010309 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10310
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010311 // Perform overload resolution.
10312 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010313 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010314 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010315 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10316 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10317
10318 if (FnDecl) {
10319 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10320 // operator.
10321
10322 // Convert the arguments.
10323 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010324 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010325 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010326
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010327 ExprResult Arg1 =
10328 PerformCopyInitialization(
10329 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10330 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10331 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010332 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010333 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010334
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010335 ExprResult Arg0 =
10336 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10337 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10338 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010339 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010340 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010341 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010342 } else {
10343 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010344 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10345 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10346 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10347 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010348 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010349 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010350
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010351 ExprResult Arg1 =
10352 PerformCopyInitialization(
10353 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10354 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10355 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010356 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10357 return ExprError();
10358 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10359 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010360 }
10361
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010362 // Determine the result type.
10363 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10364 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10365 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010366
10367 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010368 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010369 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010370 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010371 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10372 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010373
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010374 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010375 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010376 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10377 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010378
10379 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010380 FnDecl))
10381 return ExprError();
10382
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010383 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10384 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10385 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10386 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10387 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10388 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10389
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010390 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010391 } else {
10392 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10393 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10394 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010395 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10396 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10397 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10398 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010399 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010400 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010401
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010402 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10403 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10404 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10405 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10406 return ExprError();
10407 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010408 break;
10409 }
10410 }
10411
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010412 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10413 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10414 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10415 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10416 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010417 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010418 break;
10419
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010420 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10421 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10422 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010423 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010424 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010425 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010426 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10427 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010428 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010429 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010430 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10431 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10432 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010433 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010434 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10435 return ExprError();
10436
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010437 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10438 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10439 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010440 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010441 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010442 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10443 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010444 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010445 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010446 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010447 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010448
10449 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010450 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010451 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010452 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010453 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010454 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010455 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010456 return ExprError();
10457
10458 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010459 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10460 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10461 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010462 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10463 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010464
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010465 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10466 // explain why it's deleted.
10467 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10468 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010469 } else {
10470 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10471 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10472 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10473 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10474 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10475 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010476 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010477 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010478 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010479 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010480
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010481 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010482 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010483}
10484
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010485ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010486Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10487 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010488 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10489 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010490 DeclarationName OpName =
10491 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10492
10493 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10494 // expression.
10495 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10496
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010497 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010498 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10499 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10500 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010501 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010502 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010503 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010504 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10505 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10506 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010507 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010508
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010509 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010510 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010511 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010512 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010513 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010514 }
10515
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010516 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10517 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10518 return ExprError();
10519 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10520 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010521
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010522 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010523 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010524
10525 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10526
10527 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10528 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10529
10530 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10531 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10532
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010533 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10534
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010535 // Perform overload resolution.
10536 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010537 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010538 case OR_Success: {
10539 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10540 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10541
10542 if (FnDecl) {
10543 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10544 // operator.
10545
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010546 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010547
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010548 // Convert the arguments.
10549 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010550 ExprResult Arg0 =
10551 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10552 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10553 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010554 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010555 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010556
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010557 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010558 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010559 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010560 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010561 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010562 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010563 Owned(Args[1]));
10564 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10565 return ExprError();
10566
10567 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10568
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010569 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010570 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10571 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10572 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010573
10574 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010575 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10576 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010577 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010578 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010579 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010580 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10581 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010582 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10583 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010584
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010585 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10586 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010587 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010588 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10589 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010590
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010591 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010592 FnDecl))
10593 return ExprError();
10594
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010595 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010596 } else {
10597 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10598 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10599 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010600 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10601 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10602 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10603 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010604 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010605 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10606
10607 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10608 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10609 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10610 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10611 return ExprError();
10612 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010613
10614 break;
10615 }
10616 }
10617
10618 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010619 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10620 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10621 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10622 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10623 else
10624 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10625 << Args[0]->getType()
10626 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010627 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010628 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010629 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010630 }
10631
10632 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010633 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010634 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010635 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10636 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010637 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010638 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010639 return ExprError();
10640
10641 case OR_Deleted:
10642 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10643 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010644 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010645 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010646 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010647 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010648 return ExprError();
10649 }
10650
10651 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010652 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010653}
10654
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010655/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10656/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10657/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10658/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10659/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010660/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10661/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010662ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010663Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10664 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010665 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010666 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10667 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10668
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010669 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10670 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010671 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010672
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010673 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10674 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10675 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10676 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10677
10678 QualType fnType =
10679 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10680
10681 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10682 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10683 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10684
10685 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10686 // member function we're calling.
10687 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10688
10689 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10690 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10691 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10692 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10693
10694 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10695 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10696 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10697 if (difference) {
10698 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10699 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10700 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10701 << qualsString
10702 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10703 }
10704
10705 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010706 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10707 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010708 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10709
10710 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010711 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010712 call, 0))
10713 return ExprError();
10714
10715 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10716 return ExprError();
10717
10718 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10719 }
10720
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010721 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10722 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10723 return ExprError();
10724
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010725 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010726 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010727 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010728 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010729 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10730 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010731 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010732 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010733 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010734 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010735 } else {
10736 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010737 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010738
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010739 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010740 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10741 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10742 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010743
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010744 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010745 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010746
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010747 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10748 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10749 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10750 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10751 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10752 }
10753
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010754 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10755 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10756
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010757 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10758 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10759 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10760 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10761
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010762
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010763 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010764 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010765 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10766 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010767 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010768 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10769 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010770 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010771 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010772
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010773 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010774 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010775 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010776 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010777 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010778 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010779 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010780 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010781 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10782 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010783 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010784 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010785 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010786
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010787 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10788
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010789 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10790
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010791 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010792 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010793 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010794 case OR_Success:
10795 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010796 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010797 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010798 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010799 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010800 break;
10801
10802 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010803 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010804 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010805 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010806 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10807 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010808 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010809 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010810
10811 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010812 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010813 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010814 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10815 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010816 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010817 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010818
10819 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010820 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010821 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010822 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010823 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010824 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010825 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10826 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010827 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010828 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010829 }
10830
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010831 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010832
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010833 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10834 // non-member call based on that function.
10835 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10836 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10837 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10838 }
10839
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010840 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010841 }
10842
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010843 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10844 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10845 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10846
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010847 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010848 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010849 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10850 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010851 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010852
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010853 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010854 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010855 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010856 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010857
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010858 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010859 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10860 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010861 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10862 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10863 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10864 FoundDecl, Method);
10865 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10866 return ExprError();
10867 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10868 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010869
10870 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010871 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10872 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010873 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010874 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010875 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010876
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010877 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10878
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000010879 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010880 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010881
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010882 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10883 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10884 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10885 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10886
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010887 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010888 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10889 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10890 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10891 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10892
10893 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010894 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010895 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010896 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010897}
10898
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010899/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10900/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10901/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10902/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010903ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010904Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010905 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010906 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010907 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010908 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10909 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010910 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010911
10912 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10913 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10914 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010915
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010916 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10917 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010918
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010919 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10920 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010921 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010922 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10923 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10924 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10925 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010926 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010927 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010928
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010929 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000010930 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010931 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010932
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010933 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10934 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10935 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10936
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010937 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010938 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010939 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10940 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010941 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010942 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010943
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010944 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010945 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10946 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010947 //
10948 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10949 //
10950 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10951 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010952 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10953 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10954 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10955 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010956 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10957 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10958 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10959 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10960 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010961 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
10962 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010963 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010964 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
10965 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010966 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10967 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10968 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10969 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010970
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010971 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10972 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010973 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010974 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010975
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010976 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010977 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10978 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10979 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10980 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10981 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10982 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010983
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010984 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10985 {
10986 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010987 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10988 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010989 }
10990 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010991 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010992
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010993 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10994
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010995 // Perform overload resolution.
10996 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010997 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010998 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010999 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011000 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11001 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011002 break;
11003
11004 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011005 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011006 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011007 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11008 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011009 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011010 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011011 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011012 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011013 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11014 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011015 break;
11016
11017 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011018 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011019 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011020 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011021 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
11022 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011023 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011024
11025 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011026 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011027 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11028 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011029 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011030 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011031 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011032 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11033 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011034 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011035 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011036
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011037 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011038 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011039
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011040 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11041
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011042 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11043 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11044 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011045 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011046 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11047 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11048
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011049 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000011050 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011051
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011052 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11053 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11054 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011055
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011056 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011057 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011058 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11059 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011060 if (Call.isInvalid())
11061 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011062 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11063 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11064 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11065 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011066
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011067 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000011068 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011069 }
11070
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011071 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011072
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011073 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11074 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11075 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11076 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011077
11078 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011079 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011080 return ExprError();
11081
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011082 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11083 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011084
11085 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
11086 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
11087
11088 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11089 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11090 // list).
11091 Expr **MethodArgs;
11092 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
11093 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11094 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11095 } else {
11096 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
11097 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011098 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011099 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
11100 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011101
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011102 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11103 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11104 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011105 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011106 HadMultipleCandidates,
11107 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11108 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011109 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11110 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011111
11112 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11113 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011114 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11115 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11116 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11117
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011118 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011119 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011120 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, NumArgs+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011121 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011122 delete [] MethodArgs;
11123
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011124 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011125 Method))
11126 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011127
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011128 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11129 // slots in the call for them.
11130 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011131 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011132 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
11133 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11134
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011135 bool IsError = false;
11136
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011137 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011138 ExprResult ObjRes =
11139 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11140 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11141 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11142 IsError = true;
11143 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011144 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011145 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011146
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011147 // Check the argument types.
11148 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011149 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011150 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011151 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011152
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011153 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011154
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011155 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011156 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011157 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011158 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011159 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011160
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011161 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11162 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011163 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011164 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011165 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11166 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11167 IsError = true;
11168 break;
11169 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011170
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011171 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011172 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011173
11174 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11175 }
11176
11177 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11178 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11179 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Aaron Ballman4914c282012-07-20 20:40:35 +000011180 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i < NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011181 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11182 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11183 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011184 }
11185 }
11186
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011187 if (IsError) return true;
11188
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011189 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
11190
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011191 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011192 return true;
11193
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011194 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011195}
11196
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011197/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011198/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011199/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011200ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011201Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011202 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11203 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011204
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011205 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11206 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011207
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011208 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11209
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011210 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11211 //
11212 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11213 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11214 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11215 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011216 DeclarationName OpName =
11217 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011218 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011219 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011220
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011221 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011222 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011223 return ExprError();
11224
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011225 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11226 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11227 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011228
11229 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011230 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011231 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
11232 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011233 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011234
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011235 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11236
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011237 // Perform overload resolution.
11238 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011239 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011240 case OR_Success:
11241 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11242 break;
11243
11244 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11245 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11246 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011247 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011248 else
11249 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011250 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011251 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011252 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011253
11254 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011255 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11256 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011257 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011258 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011259
11260 case OR_Deleted:
11261 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11262 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011263 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011264 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011265 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011266 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011267 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011268 }
11269
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011270 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11271
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011272 // Convert the object parameter.
11273 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011274 ExprResult BaseResult =
11275 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11276 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11277 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011278 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011279 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011280
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011281 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011282 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011283 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011284 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11285 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011286
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011287 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11288 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11289 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011290 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011291 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011292 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011293
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011294 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011295 Method))
11296 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011297
11298 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011299}
11300
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011301/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11302/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11303ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11304 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11305 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11306 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11307 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11308 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011309
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011310 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11311 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11312 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011313
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011314 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11315
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011316 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11317 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11318 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11319 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11320 case OR_Success:
11321 case OR_Deleted:
11322 break;
11323
11324 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11325 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11326 << R.getLookupName();
11327 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11328 return ExprError();
11329
11330 case OR_Ambiguous:
11331 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11332 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11333 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011334 }
11335
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011336 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011337 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11338 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011339 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11340 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11341 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11342 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011343
11344 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11345 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011346 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
11347 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
11348 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11349 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11350 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11351 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11352 return true;
11353 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11354 }
11355
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011356 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11357 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11358 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11359
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011360 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011361 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11362 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011363 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11364
11365 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11366 return ExprError();
11367
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011368 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011369 return ExprError();
11370
11371 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11372}
11373
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011374/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11375/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11376/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11377/// dependent lookup.
11378/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11379/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11380/// is returned.
11381Sema::ForRangeStatus
11382Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11383 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11384 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11385 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11386 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11387 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11388 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11389 CandidateSet->clear();
11390 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11391 ExprResult MemberRef =
11392 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11393 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11394 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11395 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11396 MemberLookup,
11397 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11398 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11399 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11400 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11401 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11402 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11403 }
11404 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, MultiExprArg(), Loc, 0);
11405 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11406 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11407 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11408 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11409 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11410 }
11411 } else {
11412 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011413 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11414 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11415 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11416 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011417 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011418
11419 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, &Range, 1, Loc,
11420 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11421 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11422 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11423 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11424 }
11425 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11426 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11427 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11428
11429 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11430 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11431 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11432 }
11433 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, &Range, 1,
11434 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11435 OverloadResult,
11436 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11437 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11438 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11439 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11440 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11441 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11442 }
11443 }
11444 return FRS_Success;
11445}
11446
11447
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011448/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11449/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11450/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11451/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011452/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011453Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011454 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011455 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011456 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11457 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011458 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011459 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011460
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011461 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011462 }
11463
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011464 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011465 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11466 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011467 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011468 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011469 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011470 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011471 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011472 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011473
11474 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011475 ICE->getCastKind(),
11476 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011477 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011478 }
11479
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011480 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011481 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011482 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011483 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11484 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11485 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11486 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011487 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011488 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11489 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11490 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011491 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11492 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011493 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011494 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011495
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011496 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11497 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11498 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11499 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11500
11501 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11502 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11503 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11504 QualType ClassType
11505 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11506 QualType MemPtrType
11507 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11508
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011509 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11510 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11511 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011512 }
11513 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011514 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11515 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011516 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011517 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011518
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011519 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011520 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011521 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011522 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011523 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011524
11525 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011526 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11527 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011528 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011529 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11530 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011531 }
11532
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011533 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11534 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011535 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011536 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011537 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011538 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11539 Fn->getType(),
11540 VK_LValue,
11541 Found.getDecl(),
11542 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011543 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011544 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11545 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011546 }
11547
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011548 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011549 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011550 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11551 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11552 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11553 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11554 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011555
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011556 Expr *Base;
11557
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011558 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11559 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011560 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11561 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011562 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11563 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011564 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011565 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011566 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011567 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11568 Fn->getType(),
11569 VK_LValue,
11570 Found.getDecl(),
11571 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011572 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011573 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11574 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011575 } else {
11576 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11577 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011578 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011579 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011580 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11581 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11582 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11583 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011584 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011585 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011586
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011587 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11588 QualType type;
11589 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11590 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11591 type = Fn->getType();
11592 } else {
11593 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11594 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11595 }
11596
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011597 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11598 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11599 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011600 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011601 Fn,
11602 Found,
11603 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11604 TemplateArgs,
11605 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11606 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011607 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011608 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011609 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011610
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011611 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011612}
11613
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011614ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011615 DeclAccessPair Found,
11616 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011617 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011618}
11619
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011620} // end namespace clang